blob: 00981cc5e35e2633cc741ed25181065b88d298fd [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau5d46fbd2021-02-05 15:17:33 +01007 2021/02/05
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200131
1321. Quick reminder about HTTP
133----------------------------
134
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
137on almost anything found in the contents.
138
139However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
140formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
141correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
142
143
1441.1. The HTTP transaction model
145-------------------------------
146
147The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100148to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100149from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
150connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151will involve a new connection :
152
153 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
154
155In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
156establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
157by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
158length.
159
160Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
161to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
162however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
163response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
164header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
165
166 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
167
168Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
169power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
170but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200171a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100173Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200174keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
175second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
176page :
177
178 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
179
180This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
181latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
182correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
183the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100184server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200185
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100186The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
187time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
188are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
189parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
190carry the stream identifier.
191
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100192By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
193connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
194leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
196processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
197waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200198
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200199HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100200 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
201 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100202 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207
2081.2. HTTP request
209-----------------
210
211First, let's consider this HTTP request :
212
213 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100214 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
216 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
217 3 User-agent: my small browser
218 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
219 5 Accept: image/png
220
221
2221.2.1. The Request line
223-----------------------
224
225Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
226
227 - a METHOD : GET
228 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
229 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
230
231All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
232which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
233followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
234is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
235desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
236the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
237
238The URI itself can have several forms :
239
240 - A "relative URI" :
241
242 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
243
244 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
245 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
246
247 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
248
249 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
250
251 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
252 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
253 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
254 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
255 must accept this form too.
256
257 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
258 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
259 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100260
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200261 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
262 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
263 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
264 other protocols too.
265
266In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
267mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
268on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
269It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
270specific to the language, framework or application in use.
271
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100272HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100273assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200275
2761.2.2. The request headers
277--------------------------
278
279The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
280beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
281an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
282Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
283values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
284encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
285the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
286define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
287
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100288Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200289their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100290"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200291as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
292normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
293representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
294HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295
296The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
297that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
298is one valid form of empty line.
299
300Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
301headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
302about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
303application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
304
305Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000306 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
308 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
309 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
310
311
3121.3. HTTP response
313------------------
314
315An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
316messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
317
318 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100319 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200320 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
321 2 Content-length: 350
322 3 Content-Type: text/html
323
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200324As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
325codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
326response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100327continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
328the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
329following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
330sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
331(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
332correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
333such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
334state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
335over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
336if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
337information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200339
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003401.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341------------------------
342
343Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
344
345 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
346 - a status code : 200
347 - a reason : OK
348
349The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100350 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
351 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
352 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
353 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
354 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000356Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100357"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200358found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
359messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
360or "Authentication Required".
361
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363
364 Code When / reason
365 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
366 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
367 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
368 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100369 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
370 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371 400 for an invalid or too large request
372 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
373 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200374 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100375 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100377 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
378 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200379 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
380 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100381 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
382 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200384 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200385 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
386 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
387 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
388
389The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3904.2).
391
392
3931.3.2. The response headers
394---------------------------
395
396Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
397the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
398details.
399
400
4012. Configuring HAProxy
402----------------------
403
4042.1. Configuration file format
405------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200406
407HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
408
409 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100410 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700411 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100412 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200413
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
415a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
418
419 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
420
421 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
422 tab characters
423
424 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
425 keyword sequences listed in this document
426
427 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
428 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
429 parts of the configuration, or expressions
430
431 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
432 are supported
433
434 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
435 section
436
437This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
438generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
439figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
440
441First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
442the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
443a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
444word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
445follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
446the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
447the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
448the parts that need to be addressed.
449
450A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
451requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
452extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
453the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
454section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
455section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
456not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
457
458A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
459each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
460a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
461start a new one.
462
463Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
464that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
465applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
466"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
467processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
468ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
469which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
470In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
471of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
472identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
473such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4742, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
475
476 listen foo
477 bind :80
478
479 listen bar
480 bind :81
481
482Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
483spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
484of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
485following configurations are strictly equivalent:
486
487 global#this is the global section
488 daemon#daemonize
489 frontend foo
490 mode http # or tcp
491
492and:
493
494 global
495 daemon
496
497 # this is the public web frontend
498 frontend foo
499 mode http
500
501The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
502new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
503other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
504section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
505section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
506at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
507
508Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
509are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
510editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
511support automatic indent.
512
513In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
514positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
515modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
516anymore, and is not recommended.
517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200518
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005192.2. Quoting and escaping
520-------------------------
521
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100522In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
523that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
524possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
525in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
526('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
529very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
530the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
531also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
532delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
533word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
534remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200535
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100536If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
537(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
538
539Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
540backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
542 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
543 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
544 \\ to use a backslash
545 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
546 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
549C-language representation:
550
551 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
552 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
553 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
554 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
555
556Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
557or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
558of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200561 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
562 # hash as a comment start
563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
565evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
566dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
567backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
570character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
571is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
574entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
575name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
576represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
577hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
580 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
581 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
582 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
583 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
584 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
585 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
586 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
587 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
588 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
589 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
591 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100592 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200593 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
594 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
595 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
596 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
597 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
598
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100599There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
600necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
601by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
602they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
603escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
604characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
605case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
606if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
607own quotes.
608
609The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
610quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500611not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100612quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
613
614Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
615arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
616
617 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
618 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
619
620Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
621"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
622cannot write:
623
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
625
626because we would like the string to cut like this:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629 |---------|----|-|
630 arg1 _/ / /
631 arg2 __________/ /
632 arg3 ______________/
633
634but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
635parenthesis then garbage:
636
637 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
638 |--------|--------|
639 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
640 trailing garbage _________/
641
642The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
643quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
644processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
645this word:
646
647 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
648 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
649 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650
651So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
652still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
653the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
654the second level:
655
656 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
657 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
658 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
659 |---------||----|-|
660 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
661 arg2=blah ___________/ /
662 arg3=g _______________/
663
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500664Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100665double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
666
667 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
668 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
669 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
670 |---------||----|-|
671 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
672 arg2 ___________/ /
673 arg3 _______________/
674
675When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
676appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
677string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
678thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
679
680 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
681 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
682 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
683 |-------------| |-----||-|
684 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
685 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
686 arg3 ______________________/
687
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500688Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100689that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
690quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
691single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
692level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
693
694When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
695double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
696and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
697a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
698a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
699the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
700regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
701around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
702more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200703
704
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007052.3. Environment variables
706--------------------------
707
708HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
709interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
710configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
711optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
712shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200713underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
714list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
715arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
716before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200717
718 Example:
719
720 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
721
722 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
723
724 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
725
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200726Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
727file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200728
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200729* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
730 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
731
732* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
733 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
734 directory.
735
736* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
737
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500738* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200739 processes, separated by semicolons.
740
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500741* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200742 CLI, separated by semicolons.
743
744See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200745
7462.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200747----------------
748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100749Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100750values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
751otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
752numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
753for every keyword. Supported units are :
754
755 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
756 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
757 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
758 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
759 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
760 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
761
762
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00007632.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200764-------------
765
766 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
767 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
768 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
769 global
770 daemon
771 maxconn 256
772
773 defaults
774 mode http
775 timeout connect 5000ms
776 timeout client 50000ms
777 timeout server 50000ms
778
779 frontend http-in
780 bind *:80
781 default_backend servers
782
783 backend servers
784 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
785
786
787 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
788 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
789 global
790 daemon
791 maxconn 256
792
793 defaults
794 mode http
795 timeout connect 5000ms
796 timeout client 50000ms
797 timeout server 50000ms
798
799 listen http-in
800 bind *:80
801 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
802
803
804Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
805
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100806 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200807
808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008093. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200810--------------------
811
812Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
813are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
814of them have command-line equivalents.
815
816The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
817
818 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200819 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200821 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200822 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200824 - description
825 - deviceatlas-json-file
826 - deviceatlas-log-level
827 - deviceatlas-separator
828 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900829 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200830 - gid
831 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100832 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200833 - h1-case-adjust
834 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100835 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100836 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100837 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200838 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200839 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200840 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100841 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200842 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100843 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100844 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200845 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200846 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200847 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200848 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200849 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200850 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100851 - presetenv
852 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200853 - uid
854 - ulimit-n
855 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200856 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100857 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200858 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200859 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200860 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200861 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200862 - ssl-default-bind-options
863 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200864 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200865 - ssl-default-server-options
866 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100867 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200868 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100869 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100870 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100871 - 51degrees-data-file
872 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200873 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200874 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200875 - wurfl-data-file
876 - wurfl-information-list
877 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200878 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100879 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100880
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200881 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100882 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200883 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200884 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200885 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100886 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100887 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100888 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200889 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200890 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200891 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200892 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - noepoll
894 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000895 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100897 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300898 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000899 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100900 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200901 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200902 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200903 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000904 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000905 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200906 - tune.buffers.limit
907 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200908 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200909 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100910 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200911 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200912 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200913 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200914 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100915 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200916 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200917 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200918 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100919 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100920 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100921 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100922 - tune.lua.session-timeout
923 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200924 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100925 - tune.maxaccept
926 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200927 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200928 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200929 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +0200930 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
931 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100932 - tune.rcvbuf.client
933 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100934 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200935 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200936 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100937 - tune.sndbuf.client
938 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100939 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +0200940 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100941 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200942 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100943 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200944 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200945 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100946 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200947 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100948 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200949 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
950 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
951 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100952 - tune.zlib.memlevel
953 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200957 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958
959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009603.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200961------------------------------------
962
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200963ca-base <dir>
964 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100965 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
966 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
967 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200968
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969chroot <jail dir>
970 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
971 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
972 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
973 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
974 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100975 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100976
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100977cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
978 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
979 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
980 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
981 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
982 set. These sets have the format
983
984 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
985
986 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100987 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100988 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
989 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100990 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
991 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100992 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100993 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100994 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100995 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100996 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
997 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
998 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
999 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001000
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001001 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1002 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1003 on the machine's word size.
1004
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001005 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001006 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1007 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1008 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1009 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1010 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1011 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001012
1013 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001014 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1015
1016 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1017 # first 4 CPUs
1018
1019 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1020 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1021 # word size.
1022
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001023 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001024 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001025 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1026 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1027 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1028
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001029 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1030 # and so on.
1031 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1032 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1033 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1034
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001035 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001036 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1037 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1038 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1039
1040 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1041 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1042 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1043
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001044 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1045 # and a thread range.
1046 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1047 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1048 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1049
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001050crt-base <dir>
1051 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001052 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1053 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001054
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001055daemon
1056 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1057 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001058 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1059 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001060
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001061deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1062 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001063 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001064
1065deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001066 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001067 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1068
1069deviceatlas-separator <char>
1070 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1071 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1072
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001073deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001074 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1075 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1076 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001077
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001078external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001079 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1080 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001081 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1082 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1083 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1084 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1085 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001086
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001087gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001088 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001089 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1090 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001091 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1092 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001094
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001095group <group name>
1096 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1097 See also "gid" and "user".
1098
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001099hard-stop-after <time>
1100 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1101
1102 Arguments :
1103 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1104 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1105 SIGUSR1 signal.
1106
1107 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1108 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1109 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1110
1111 Example:
1112 global
1113 hard-stop-after 30s
1114
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001115h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1116 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1117 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1118 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1119 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001120 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001121 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1122 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1123 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1124 specified in a proxy.
1125
1126 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1127 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1128 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1129 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1130 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1131 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1132 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1133
1134 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1135 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1136 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1137 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1138 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1139
1140 Example:
1141 global
1142 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1143
1144 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1145 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1146
1147h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1148 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1149 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1150 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1151 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1152 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1153 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1154 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1155 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1156
1157 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1158 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1159 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1160
1161 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1162 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1163
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001164insecure-fork-wanted
1165 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1166 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1167 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1168 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1169 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1170 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1171 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1172 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1173 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1174 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1175 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1176 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1177 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1178 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1179 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1180 disable it.
1181
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001182insecure-setuid-wanted
1183 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1184 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1185 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1186 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1187 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1188 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1189 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1190 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1191 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1192 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1193 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1194 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1195 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1196 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1197
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001198issuers-chain-path <dir>
1199 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1200 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1201 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1202 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1203 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1204 "issuers-chain-path".
1205 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1206 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1207 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1208 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1209 will share the chain in memory.
1210
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001211localpeer <name>
1212 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1213 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1214 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1215 the configuration parsing.
1216
1217 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1218 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1219
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001220log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001221 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001222 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001223 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001224 configured with "log global".
1225
1226 <address> can be one of:
1227
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001228 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001229 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1230 port).
1231
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001232 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1233 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1234 port).
1235
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001236 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001237 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1238 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001239 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001240
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001241 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1242 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1243 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1244 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1245 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1246 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1247 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1248 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1249 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1250 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1251 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1252 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1253 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1254 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001255 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1256 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001257
1258 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1259 "fd@2", see above.
1260
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001261 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1262 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1263 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1264 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1265 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1266
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001267 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1268 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001269
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001270 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1271 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1272 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1273 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1274 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1275 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1276 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1277 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1278 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1279 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001280 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1281 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001282
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001283 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1284 one of the following :
1285
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001286 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1287 field is stripped. This is the default.
1288 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1289 rfc3164.
1290
1291 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001292 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1293
1294 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1295 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1296
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001297 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1298 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1299 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1300 designed to be used with a local log server.
1301
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001302 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1303 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1304 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1305 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1306 logger consumes.
1307
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001308 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1309 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1310 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1311 used with a local log server.
1312
1313 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1314 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1315 designed to be used with a local log server.
1316
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001317 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1318 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1319 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1320 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1321
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001322 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1323 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1324 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1325 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1326 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1327
1328 <sample_size>
1329 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1330 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1331 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1332 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1333 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1334
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001335 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001336
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001337 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1338 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1339 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1340
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001341 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1342 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1343 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1344 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001345
1346 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001347 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1348 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1349 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1350 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1351 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1352 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001353
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001354 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001355
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001356log-send-hostname [<string>]
1357 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1358 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1359 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1360 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1361 the logs.
1362
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001363log-tag <string>
1364 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1365 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1366 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001367 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001368
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001369lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001370 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1371 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1372 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1373 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1374 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1375 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001376 used multiple times.
1377
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001378lua-load-per-thread <file>
1379 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1380 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1381 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1382 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1383 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1384 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1385 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1386 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1387 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1388 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1389 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1390 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1391 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1392 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1393 times.
1394
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001395lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1396 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1397 variable.
1398 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1399 to "path".
1400
1401 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1402 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1403 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1404 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1405 will be checked earlier.
1406
1407 As an example by specifying the following path:
1408
1409 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1410 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1411
1412 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1413 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1414 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1415 paths if that does not exist either.
1416
1417 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1418 documentation.
1419
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001420master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001421 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1422 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1423 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001424 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001425 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1426 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001427 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1428 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1429 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1430 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1431 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001432
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001433 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001434
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001435mworker-max-reloads <number>
1436 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001437 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001438 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1439 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1440 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1441
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001442nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001443 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1444 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1445 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001446 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1447 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001448 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1449 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1450 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001451
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001452nbthread <number>
1453 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001454 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1455 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1456 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1457 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1458 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001459 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1460 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1461 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1462 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1463 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1464 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1465 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001466
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001467pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001468 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1469 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1470 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1471 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001472
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001473pp2-never-send-local
1474 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1475 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1476 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1477 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1478 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1479 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1480 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1481 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1482 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1483 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1484 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1485
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001486presetenv <name> <value>
1487 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1488 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1489 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1490 and "unsetenv".
1491
1492resetenv [<name> ...]
1493 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1494 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1495 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1496 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1497 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1498 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1499 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1500 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1501
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001502stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001503 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1504 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1505 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1506 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1507 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1508 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001509 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001510 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1511 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1512 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1513 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001514
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001515server-state-base <directory>
1516 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001517 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1518 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001519
1520server-state-file <file>
1521 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1522 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1523 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1524 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1525 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1526 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1527 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1528 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001529 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1530 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001531
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001532setenv <name> <value>
1533 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1534 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1535 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1536 and "unsetenv".
1537
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001538set-dumpable
1539 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001540 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1541 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1542 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1543 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1544 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1545 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1546 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1547 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1548 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1549 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1550 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1551 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1552 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1553 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1554 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1555 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1556 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001557
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001558ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1559 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1560 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001561 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001562 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001563 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1564 information and recommendations see e.g.
1565 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1566 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1567 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1568 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001569
1570ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1571 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1572 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1573 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1574 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1575 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001576 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1577 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1578 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001579 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001580
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001581ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1582 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1583 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1584 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1585 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1586 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1587
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001588ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1589 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1590 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1591 keyword to see available options.
1592
1593 Example:
1594 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001595 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001596
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001597ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1599 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001600 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001601 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001602 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1603 information and recommendations see e.g.
1604 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1605 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1606 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1607 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1608 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001609
1610ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1612 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1613 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1614 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1615 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001616 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1617 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1618 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1619 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001620
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001621ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1623 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1624 keyword to see available options.
1625
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001626ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1627 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1628 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1629 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001630 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001631 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001632 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1633 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1634 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1635 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001636 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1637 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1638 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1639
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001640ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1641 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1642 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001643 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001644 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001645 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1646
1647 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001648
1649 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1650 and won't try to remove them.
1651
1652 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1653
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001654ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001655 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001656 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1657 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001658
1659 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1660 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1661 optimize the startup time.
1662
1663 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1664 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1665 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1666
1667 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001668 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001669
1670 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001671 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1672
1673 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1674 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1675 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1676 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1677 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1678 bind configuration..
1679
1680 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1681 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1682 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1683 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1684 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1685 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1686 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1687 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1688
1689 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1690
1691 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1692 a cert bundle.
1693
1694 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1695 separately in several "crt".
1696
1697 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1698 since files are loading separately.
1699
1700 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1701 required to commit them.
1702
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001703 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001704 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001705
1706 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1707
1708 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1709
1710 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1711 not provided in the PEM file.
1712
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001713 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1714 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1715
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001716 The default behavior is "all".
1717
1718 Example:
1719 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1720 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1721 ssl-load-extra-files none
1722
1723 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1724
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001725ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1726 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1727 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1728 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1729
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001730ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001731 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001732 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1733 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1734 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1735 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1736 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1737 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001738 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001739
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001740stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1741 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1742 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1743 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001744 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001745 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001746
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001747 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1748 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1749 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001750
1751stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1752 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1753 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001754 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001755
1756stats maxconn <connections>
1757 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1758 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1759
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001760uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001761 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001762 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1763 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1764 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1765
1766ulimit-n <number>
1767 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1768 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1769 option.
1770
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001771unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1772 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1773
1774 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1775 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1776 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1777 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1778 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1779 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1780 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1781 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1782 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1783 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1784
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001785unsetenv [<name> ...]
1786 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1787 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1788 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1789 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1790 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1791 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1792 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1793
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001794user <user name>
1795 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1796 See also "uid" and "group".
1797
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001798node <name>
1799 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1800
1801 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1802 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1803 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1804 traffic.
1805
1806description <text>
1807 Add a text that describes the instance.
1808
1809 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1810 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1811 "<" and ">" characters.
1812
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100181351degrees-data-file <file path>
1814 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001815 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001816
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001817 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001818 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1819
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000182051degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001821 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1822 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1823 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1824
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001825 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001826 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1827
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200182851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001829 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1830 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1831
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001832 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1833 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1834
183551degrees-cache-size <number>
1836 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1837 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1838 By default, this cache is disabled.
1839
1840 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001841 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1842
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001843wurfl-data-file <file path>
1844 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1845 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1846
1847 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1848 with USE_WURFL=1.
1849
1850wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1851 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1852 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1853 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1854
1855 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1856
1857 Valid WURFL properties are:
1858 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1859
1860 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1861 device.
1862
1863 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1864 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1865
1866 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1867 particular web request.
1868
1869 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1870 used Libwurfl API version.
1871
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001872 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1873 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1874
1875 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1876 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1877
1878 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1879
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001880 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1881 with USE_WURFL=1.
1882
1883wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1884 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1885 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1886
1887 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1888 with USE_WURFL=1.
1889
1890wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1891 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1892 thus before the chroot.
1893
1894 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1895 with USE_WURFL=1.
1896
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001897wurfl-cache-size <size>
1898 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1899 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001900 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001901 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001902
1903 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1904 with USE_WURFL=1.
1905
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001906strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001907 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1908 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
1909 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
1910 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
1911 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001912
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019133.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001914-----------------------
1915
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001916busy-polling
1917 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1918 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1919 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1920 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1921 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1922 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1923 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1924 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1925 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1926 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1927 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1928 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1929 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1930 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1931 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1932 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1933 "poll" pollers.
1934
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001935 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1936 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1937 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1938
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001939max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1940 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1941 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1942 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1943 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1944 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1945 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1946 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1947 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1948
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001949maxconn <number>
1950 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1951 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1952 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001953 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1954 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1955 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1956 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001957 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1958 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1959 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1960 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1961 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1962 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001963
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001964maxconnrate <number>
1965 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1966 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1967 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1968 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1969 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1970 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1971 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1972 fairness.
1973
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001974maxcomprate <number>
1975 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001976 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001977 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1978 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1979 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001980 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001981 default value.
1982
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001983maxcompcpuusage <number>
1984 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1985 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1986 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1987 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1988 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1989 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1990 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1991 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1992
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001993maxpipes <number>
1994 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1995 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1996 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1997 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1998 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1999 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2000
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002001maxsessrate <number>
2002 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2003 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2004 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2005 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2006 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2007 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2008 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2009 fairness.
2010
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002011maxsslconn <number>
2012 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2013 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2014 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2015 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2016 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2017 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2018 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002019 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2020 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2021 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2022 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2023 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2024 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2025 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002026
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002027maxsslrate <number>
2028 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2029 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2030 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2031 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2032 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2033 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2034 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2035 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2036 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2037 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2038
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002039maxzlibmem <number>
2040 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2041 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2042 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002043 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2044 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2045 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2046
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002047noepoll
2048 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2049 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002050 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002051
2052nokqueue
2053 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2054 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2055 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2056
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002057noevports
2058 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2059 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2060 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2061 also "nopoll".
2062
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002063nopoll
2064 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2065 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002066 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002067 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2068 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002069
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002070nosplice
2071 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002072 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002073 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002074 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002075 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2076 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2077 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2078 "option splice-response".
2079
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002080nogetaddrinfo
2081 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2082 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2083
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002084noreuseport
2085 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2086 command line argument "-dR".
2087
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002088profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2089 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2090 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2091 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2092 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002093 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002094 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2095 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2096 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2097 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2098
2099 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2100 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2101 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2102 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2103 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002104 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2105 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2106 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2107 CLI.
2108
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002109spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002110 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2111 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2112 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2113 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2114 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2115 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002116
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002117ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002118 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002119 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002120 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2121 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2122 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2123 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2124 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002125 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2126 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002127 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2128 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2129 openssl configuration file uses:
2130 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2131
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002132ssl-mode-async
2133 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002134 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002135 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2136 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2137 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002138 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002139 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002140
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002141tune.buffers.limit <number>
2142 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2143 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2144 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2145 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2146 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002147 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002148 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2149 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2150 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2151 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2152 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2153 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2154 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2155 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2156 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2157
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002158tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2159 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2160 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2161 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2162 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2163
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002164tune.bufsize <number>
2165 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2166 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2167 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2168 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2169 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2170 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2171 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002172 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2173 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2174 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002175 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002176 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2177 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2178 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002179
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002180tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2181 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002182
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002183tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2184 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2185 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2186 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2187 this value. The default value is 1.
2188
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002189tune.fail-alloc
2190 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2191 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2192 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2193 gracefully.
2194
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002195tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2196 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2197 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2198 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2199 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2200 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2201
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002202tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2203 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2204 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2205 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2206 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2207 change it.
2208
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002209tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2210 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002211 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2212 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002213 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2214 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2215 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2216 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2217 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2218
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002219tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2220 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2221 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2222 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2223 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2224 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2225 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2226 recommended not to change this value.
2227
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002228tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2229 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2230 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2231 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2232 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2233 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2234 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2235 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2236
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002237tune.http.cookielen <number>
2238 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2239 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2240 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2241 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2242 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2243 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2244 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2245 to change this value.
2246
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002247tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002248 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2249 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002250 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002251 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002252 configuration directives too.
2253 The default value is 1024.
2254
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002255tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2256 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2257 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2258 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2259 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2260 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2261 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002262 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2263 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2264 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002265
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002266tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2267 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2268 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2269 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2270 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2271 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2272 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
2273 this option to "off". The default is on.
2274
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002275tune.idletimer <timeout>
2276 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2277 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2278 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2279 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2280 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2281 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002282 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002283 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002284 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2285
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002286tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2287 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2288 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2289 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2290 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2291 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2292 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2293 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2294 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2295 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2296
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002297tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2298 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002299 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002300 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2301 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002302 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002303 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2304 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2305
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002306tune.lua.maxmem
2307 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2308 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2309 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2310 memory.
2311
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002312tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2313 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002314 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2315 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002316 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002317
2318tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2319 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2320 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2321 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2322 check servers.
2323
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002324tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2325 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2326 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2327 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002328 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002329
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002330tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002331 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2332 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2333 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2334 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2335 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2336 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2337 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2338 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2339 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2340 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002341
2342tune.maxpollevents <number>
2343 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2344 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2345 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2346 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2347 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2348
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002349tune.maxrewrite <number>
2350 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2351 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2352 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2353 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2354 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2355 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2356 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2357 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2358 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2359 bufsize.
2360
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002361tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2362 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2363 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2364 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2365 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2366 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2367 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2368 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2369 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2370 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002371 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2372 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002373 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2374 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2375 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2376 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2377 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2378 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2379 setting this parameter to 0.
2380
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002381tune.pipesize <number>
2382 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2383 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2384 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2385 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2386 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2387 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2388
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002389tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2390 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2391 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2392 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2393 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2394 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2395 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002396 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002397
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002398tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2399 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2400 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2401 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2402 default is 20.
2403
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002404tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2405tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2406 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2407 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2408 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002409 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002410 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002411 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2412 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2413
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002414tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002415 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002416 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2417 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2418 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2419 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2420
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002421tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002422 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002423 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002424 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2425 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2426 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2427
2428tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2429 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2430 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2431 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2432 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2433 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2434 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2435 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2436 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2437 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002438
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002439tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2440tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2441 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2442 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2443 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002444 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002445 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002446 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2447 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2448 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2449 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2450 notifying haproxy again.
2451
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002452tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002453 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2454 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2455 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002456 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002457 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002458 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002459 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2460 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2461 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002462 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2463 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002464
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002465tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002466 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002467 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2468 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2469 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2470 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2471 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2472
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002473tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2474 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2475 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2476 performances. This is disabled by default.
2477
2478 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2479 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2480
2481 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2482
2483 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2484
2485 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2486
2487 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2488 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2489 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2490
2491 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2492 converted.
2493
2494 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2495 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2496 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2497 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2498 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2499 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2500 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002501 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2502 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002503
2504 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2505
2506 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2507 only need this line:
2508
2509 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2510
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002511tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2512 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002513 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002514 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2515 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2516 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2517 being used for too long.
2518
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002519tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2520 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2521 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2522 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2523 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2524 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2525 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2526 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2527 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2528 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2529 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002530 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002531 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002532
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002533tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2534 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2535 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2536 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2537 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002538 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002539 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2540 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002541 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2542 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002543
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002544tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2545 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2546 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2547 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2548 1000 entries.
2549
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002550tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2551 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2552 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2553 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2554
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002555tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002556tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002557tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2558tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2559tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002560 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2561 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2562 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2563 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2564 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2565 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2566 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2567 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002568
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002569 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2570 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2571 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2572 all available space is consumed.
2573 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2574 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2575 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002576
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002577tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2578 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002579 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002580 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002581 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002582 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2583
2584tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2585 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2586 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002587 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2588 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002589
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025903.3. Debugging
2591--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002592
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002593quiet
2594 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2595 line argument "-q".
2596
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002597zero-warning
2598 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2599 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2600 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2601 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2602 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2603 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2604
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010026063.4. Userlists
2607--------------
2608It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2609http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2610it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2611
2612userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002613 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002614 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2615
2616group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002617 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002618 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2619 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2620
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002621user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2622 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002623 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2624 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002625 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2626 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2627 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2628 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002629
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002630 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2631 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2632 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2633 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2634 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2635 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2636 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2637 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2638 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002639
2640 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002641 userlist L1
2642 group G1 users tiger,scott
2643 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002644
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002645 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2646 user scott insecure-password elgato
2647 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002648
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002649 userlist L2
2650 group G1
2651 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002652
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002653 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2654 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2655 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002656
2657 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002658
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002659
26603.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002661----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002662It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2663several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2664instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2665values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2666automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2667In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2668using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2669tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2670reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2671Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2672that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2673each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002674
2675peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002676 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002677 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2678
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002679bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2680 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2681 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2682
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002683disabled
2684 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2685 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2686 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2687
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002688default-bind [param*]
2689 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2690
2691default-server [param*]
2692 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2693
2694 Arguments:
2695 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2696 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2697 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2698 details.
2699
2700
2701 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2702
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002703enable
2704 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2705
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002706log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002707 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2708 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2709 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2710 more details.
2711
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002712peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002713 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2714 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002715 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2716 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2717 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2718 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2719 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002720
2721 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2722 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2723
2724 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002725 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2726 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2727 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002728
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002729 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2730 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002731
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002732 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2733 "server" keyword explanation below).
2734
2735server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002736 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002737 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2738 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2739 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2740 of this "peers" section).
2741 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2742
2743
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002744 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002745 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002746 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002747 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2748 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2749 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002750
2751 backend mybackend
2752 mode tcp
2753 balance roundrobin
2754 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2755 stick on src
2756
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002757 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2758 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002759
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002760 Example:
2761 peers mypeers
2762 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2763 default-server ssl verify none
2764 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2765 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002766
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002767
2768table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2769 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2770
2771 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2772 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002773 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002774 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2775 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2776 "stick-table" keyword).
2777
2778 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2779 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2780 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2781 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2782 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2783 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2784 of the stick-table name as follows:
2785
2786 peers mypeers
2787 peer A ...
2788 peer B ...
2789 table t1 ...
2790
2791 frontend fe1
2792 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2793
2794 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2795 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2796
2797 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2798 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2799 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2800 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2801 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2802 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2803 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2804
2805 peers mypeers
2806 peer A ...
2807 peer B ...
2808 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2809
2810 backend t1
2811 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2812
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002813 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002814 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2815 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2816
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090028173.6. Mailers
2818------------
2819It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2820If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2821in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2822
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002823mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002824 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2825 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2826
2827mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2828 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2829
2830 Example:
2831 mailers mymailers
2832 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2833 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2834
2835 backend mybackend
2836 mode tcp
2837 balance roundrobin
2838
2839 email-alert mailers mymailers
2840 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2841 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2842
2843 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2844 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2845
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002846timeout mail <time>
2847 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2848 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2849 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2850 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2851
2852 Example:
2853 mailers mymailers
2854 timeout mail 20s
2855 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002856
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020028573.7. Programs
2858-------------
2859In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2860master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2861managed the same way as the workers.
2862
2863During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2864sequence as a worker:
2865
2866 - the master is re-executed
2867 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2868 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2869 instance of the program
2870
2871During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2872
2873program <name>
2874 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2875 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2876 the management guide).
2877
2878command <command> [arguments*]
2879 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2880 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2881 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2882 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2883
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002884user <user name>
2885 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2886 See also "group".
2887
2888group <group name>
2889 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2890 See also "user".
2891
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002892option start-on-reload
2893no option start-on-reload
2894 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2895 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2896 program section.
2897
2898
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010028993.8. HTTP-errors
2900----------------
2901
2902It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2903imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2904several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2905
2906http-errors <name>
2907 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2908 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2909
2910errorfile <code> <file>
2911 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2912
2913 Arguments :
2914 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002915 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01002916 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002917
2918 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2919 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2920 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2921 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2922 before any chroot is performed.
2923
2924 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2925
2926 Example:
2927 http-errors website-1
2928 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2929 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2930 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2931
2932 http-errors website-2
2933 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2934 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2935 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2936
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020029373.9. Rings
2938----------
2939
2940It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2941servers or traces.
2942
2943ring <ringname>
2944 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2945
2946description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002947 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002948 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2949
2950format <format>
2951 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2952
2953 Arguments:
2954 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2955 one of the following :
2956
2957 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2958 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2959 designed to be used with a local log server.
2960
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002961 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
2962 field is stripped. This is the default.
2963 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
2964 rfc3164.
2965
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002966 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2967 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2968 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2969 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2970 is the default.
2971
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01002972 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002973 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2974
2975 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2976 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2977
2978 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2979 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2980 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2981 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2982 logger consumes.
2983
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02002984 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
2985 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
2986 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
2987 with a local log server.
2988
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002989 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2990 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2991 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2992 used with a local log server.
2993
2994maxlen <length>
2995 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2996 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2997 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2998
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002999server <name> <address> [param*]
3000 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3001 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3002 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3003 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3004 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3005 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3006 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3007 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3008 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003009 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3010 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003011
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003012size <size>
3013 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3014 set to BUFSIZE.
3015
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003016timeout connect <timeout>
3017 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3018
3019 Arguments :
3020 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3021 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3022 as explained at the top of this document.
3023
3024timeout server <timeout>
3025 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3026
3027 Arguments :
3028 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3029 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3030 as explained at the top of this document.
3031
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003032 Example:
3033 global
3034 log ring@myring local7
3035
3036 ring myring
3037 description "My local buffer"
3038 format rfc3164
3039 maxlen 1200
3040 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003041 timeout connect 5s
3042 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003043 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003044
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020030453.10. Log forwarding
3046-------------------
3047
3048It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3049haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3050
3051log-forward <name>
3052 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3053
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003054backlog <conns>
3055 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3056 on connections accept.
3057
3058bind <addr> [param*]
3059 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003060 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3061 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3062 syslog protocol over TCP.
3063 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003064 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3065
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003066dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003067 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3068 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3069 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3070 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003071 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003072
3073log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003074log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003075 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3076 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3077 documentation.
3078 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3079 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3080 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3081 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3082 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3083
3084 Example:
3085 global
3086 log stderr format iso local7
3087
3088 ring myring
3089 description "My local buffer"
3090 format rfc5424
3091 maxlen 1200
3092 size 32764
3093 timeout connect 5s
3094 timeout server 10s
3095 # syslog tcp server
3096 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3097
3098 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003099 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3100 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003101 # all messages on stderr
3102 log global
3103 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3104 log ring@myring local0
3105 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3106 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3107 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3108 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3109 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003110
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003111maxconn <conns>
3112 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3113 10 is the default.
3114
3115timeout client <timeout>
3116 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3117
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020031184. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003119----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003120
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003121Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003122 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3123 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3124 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3125 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003126
3127A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3128connections.
3129
3130A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3131to forward incoming connections.
3132
3133A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3134parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3135
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003136A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3137ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3138sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3139the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3140explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3141from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3142"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3143for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3144to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3145optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3146are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3147any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3148names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3149that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3150duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3151names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3152
3153Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3154settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3155of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3156profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3157timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3158
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003159All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3160'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3161case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3162
3163Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3164logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3165proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3166However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3167name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3168
3169Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3170and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003171bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003172protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3173modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3174arbitrary criteria.
3175
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003176In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3177a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003178the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003179
3180 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3181 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3182 between responses and new requests.
3183
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003184 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3185 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3186 client-facing connection remains open.
3187
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003188 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3189 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003190
3191The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3192frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3193following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003194weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003195
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003196 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003197
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003198 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3199 ----+-----+-----+----
3200 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3201 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003202 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3203 ----+-----+-----+----
3204 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003206
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032084.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3209--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003211The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3212limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3213they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3214limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003215marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003216option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003217and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3218with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3219specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003220
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003221
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003222 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3223------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3224acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003225backlog X X X -
3226balance X - X X
3227bind - X X -
3228bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003229capture cookie - X X -
3230capture request header - X X -
3231capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003232clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3233clitcpka-idle X X X -
3234clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003235compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003236cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003237declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003238default-server X - X X
3239default_backend X X X -
3240description - X X X
3241disabled X X X X
3242dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003243email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003244email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003245email-alert mailers X X X X
3246email-alert myhostname X X X X
3247email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003248enabled X X X X
3249errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003250errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003251errorloc X X X X
3252errorloc302 X X X X
3253-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3254errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003255force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003256filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003257fullconn X - X X
3258grace X X X X
3259hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003260http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003261http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003262http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003263http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003264http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003265http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003266http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003267http-check set-var X - X X
3268http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003269http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003270http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003271http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003272http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003273http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003274id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003275ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003276load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003277log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003278log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003279log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003280log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003281max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003282maxconn X X X -
3283mode X X X X
3284monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003285monitor-uri X X X -
3286option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3287option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3288option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3289option allbackups (*) X - X X
3290option checkcache (*) X - X X
3291option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3292option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003293option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003294option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3295option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003296-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3297option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003298option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3299option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003300option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003301option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003302option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003303option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003304option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003305option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3306option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3307option httpchk X - X X
3308option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003309option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003310option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003311option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003312option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003313option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003314option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3315option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3316option logasap (*) X X X -
3317option mysql-check X - X X
3318option nolinger (*) X X X X
3319option originalto X X X X
3320option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003321option pgsql-check X - X X
3322option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003323option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003324option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003325option smtpchk X - X X
3326option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3327option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3328option splice-request (*) X X X X
3329option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003330option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003331option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3332option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3333-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003334option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003335option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3336option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3337option tcpka X X X X
3338option tcplog X X X X
3339option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003340external-check command X - X X
3341external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003342persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3343rate-limit sessions X X X -
3344redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003345-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003346retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003347retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003348server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003349server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003350server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003351source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003352srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3353srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3354srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003355stats admin - X X X
3356stats auth X X X X
3357stats enable X X X X
3358stats hide-version X X X X
3359stats http-request - X X X
3360stats realm X X X X
3361stats refresh X X X X
3362stats scope X X X X
3363stats show-desc X X X X
3364stats show-legends X X X X
3365stats show-node X X X X
3366stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003367-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3368stick match - - X X
3369stick on - - X X
3370stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003371stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003372stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003373tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003374tcp-check connect X - X X
3375tcp-check expect X - X X
3376tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003377tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003378tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003379tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003380tcp-check set-var X - X X
3381tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003382tcp-request connection - X X -
3383tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003384tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003385tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003386tcp-response content - - X X
3387tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003388timeout check X - X X
3389timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003390timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003391timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003392timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3393timeout http-request X X X X
3394timeout queue X - X X
3395timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003396timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003397timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003398timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003399transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003400unique-id-format X X X -
3401unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003402use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003403use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003404use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003405------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3406 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003407
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034094.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3410---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411
3412This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3413
3414
3415acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3416 Declare or complete an access list.
3417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3418 no | yes | yes | yes
3419 Example:
3420 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3421 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3422 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003424 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003425
3426
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003427backlog <conns>
3428 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3430 yes | yes | yes | no
3431 Arguments :
3432 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3433 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003434 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003435
3436 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3437 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3438 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3439 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3440 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3441 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3442 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3443 backlog parameter.
3444
3445 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3446 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3447 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3448
3449 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3450
3451
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003452balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003453balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3456 yes | no | yes | yes
3457 Arguments :
3458 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3459 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3460 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3461 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3462
3463 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3464 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3465 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3466 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003467 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003468 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003469 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3470 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3471 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3472 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3473 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3474 it, so that you don't worry.
3475
3476 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3477 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3478 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3479 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3480 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3481 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3482 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3483 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003484
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003485 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3486 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3487 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3488 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3489 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3490 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3491 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003492 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3493 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3494 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003495
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003496 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003497 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003498 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3499 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003500 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003501 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3502 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3503 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3504 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3505 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003506 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3507 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3508 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3509 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3510 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3511 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003512
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003513 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3514 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3515 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3516 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3517 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3518 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3519 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3520 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003521 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003523 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3524 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3525 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003526
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003527 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3528 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3529 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3530 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3531 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3532 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3533 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3534 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3535 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3536 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3537 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3538 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003539
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003540 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003541 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3542 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3543 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3544 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3545 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3546 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3547 URIs start with a leading "/".
3548
3549 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3550 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3551 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3552 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3553
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003554 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3555 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3556 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3557 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3558
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003559 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003560 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3561
3562 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003563 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3564 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003565 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3566 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3567 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3568 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003569 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003570 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3571 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003572
3573 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3574 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3575 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3576 server will receive the request.
3577
3578 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3579 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3580 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3581 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3582 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003583 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3584 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3585 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003586
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003587 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3588 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3589 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3590 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3591 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003593 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003594 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3595 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3596 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3597
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003598 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3599 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3600 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3601
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003602 random
3603 random(<draws>)
3604 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003605 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3606 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3607 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3608 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003609 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3610 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3611 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3612 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3613 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3614 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3615 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3616 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3617 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3618 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3619 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3620 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3621 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3622 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3623 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3624 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3625 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3626 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3627 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3628 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003629
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003630 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003631 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003632 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3633 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3634 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3635 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3636 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3637 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003638 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003639 used instead.
3640
3641 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3642 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3643 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3644 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3645
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003646 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3647 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3648 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3649
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003650 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003651
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003652 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003653 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3654 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003655
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003656 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3657 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3658 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003659
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003660 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003661 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003662 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3663 NTLM relies on.
3664
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003665 Examples :
3666 balance roundrobin
3667 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003668 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003669 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3670 balance hdr(host)
3671 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003672
3673 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3674 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003676 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003677 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3678 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3679 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003680 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003681
3682 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3683 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3684 defaults to 16 kB.
3685
3686 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3687 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3688
3689 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3690 Round Robin.
3691
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003692 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003693 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3694 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3695 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3696
3697 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3698
3699 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003700 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003701 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3702 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3703 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003704
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003705 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003706
3707
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003708bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3709bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003710 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3712 no | yes | yes | no
3713 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003714 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3715 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3716 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3717 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003718 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003719 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3720 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3721 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3722 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3723 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3724 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003725 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003726 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3727 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003728 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003729 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3730 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003731 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003732 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3733 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003734 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003735 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3736 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3737 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3738 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3739 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3740 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3741 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003742 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3743 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3744 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003745 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3746 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3747 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3748 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003749 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3750 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3751 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003752
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003753 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3754 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003755 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3756 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3757 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003758 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3759 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3760 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3761 the range.
3762
3763 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3764 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3765 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3766 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3767 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3768 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3769 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003770 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003771 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003772
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003773 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003774 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003775 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3776 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3777 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3778 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3779 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3780 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3781
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003782 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3783 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3784 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3785 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003786
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003787 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3788 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3789 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3790 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3791 in a frontend.
3792
3793 Example :
3794 listen http_proxy
3795 bind :80,:443
3796 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003797 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003798
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003799 listen http_https_proxy
3800 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003801 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003802
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003803 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3804 bind ipv6@:80
3805 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3806 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3807
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003808 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003809 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003810
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003811 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3812 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3813 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3814 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3815 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3816
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003817 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003818 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003819
3820
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003821bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003822 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3824 yes | yes | yes | yes
3825 Arguments :
3826 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3827 may be used to override a default value.
3828
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003829 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003830 option may be combined with other numbers.
3831
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003832 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003833 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3834 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3835 missing from all processes.
3836
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003837 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003838 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003839 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3840 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3841 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3842 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3843 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003844 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003845
3846 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3847 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3848 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3849 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3850 and 'even' instances.
3851
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003852 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3853 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3854 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3855 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003856
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003857 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3858 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3859
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003860 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3861 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3862 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3863
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003864 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3865 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3866
3867 Example :
3868 listen app_ip1
3869 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003870 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003871
3872 listen app_ip2
3873 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003874 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003875
3876 listen management
3877 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003878 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003879
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003880 listen management
3881 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3882 bind-process 1-4
3883
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003884 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003885
3886
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003887capture cookie <name> len <length>
3888 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3890 no | yes | yes | no
3891 Arguments :
3892 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3893 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3894 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3895 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003896 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003897
3898 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3899 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3900 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3901 right if it exceeds <length>.
3902
3903 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3904 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3905 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3906 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3907
3908 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3909 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3910 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3911
3912 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3913 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3914 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003915 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3916 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3917 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003918
3919 Example:
3920 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3921
3922 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003923 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003924
3925
3926capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003927 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3929 no | yes | yes | no
3930 Arguments :
3931 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003932 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003933 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3934 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3935 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3936
3937 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3938 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3939 it exceeds <length>.
3940
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003941 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003942 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3943 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003944 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3945 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3946 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3947 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003948 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003949 environments to find where the request came from.
3950
3951 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3952 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3953 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3954 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003955
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003956 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3957 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3958 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3959 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3960 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003961
3962 Example:
3963 capture request header Host len 15
3964 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003965 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003966
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003967 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003968 about logging.
3969
3970
3971capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003972 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003973 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3974 no | yes | yes | no
3975 Arguments :
3976 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003977 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003978 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3979 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3980 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3981
3982 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3983 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3984 it exceeds <length>.
3985
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003986 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003987 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3988 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3989 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003990 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3991 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3992 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3993 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003994
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003995 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3996 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3997 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3998 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3999 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004000
4001 Example:
4002 capture response header Content-length len 9
4003 capture response header Location len 15
4004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004005 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006 about logging.
4007
4008
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004009clitcpka-cnt <count>
4010 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4011 the connection on the client side.
4012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4013 yes | yes | yes | no
4014 Arguments :
4015 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4016
4017 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4018 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004019 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4020 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004021
4022 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4023
4024
4025clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4026 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4027 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4028 client side.
4029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4030 yes | yes | yes | no
4031 Arguments :
4032 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4033 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4034 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4035 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4036
4037 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4038 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004039 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4040 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004041
4042 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4043
4044
4045clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4046 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4048 yes | yes | yes | no
4049 Arguments :
4050 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4051 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4052 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4053 document.
4054
4055 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4056 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004057 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4058 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004059
4060 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4061
4062
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004063compression algo <algorithm> ...
4064compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004065compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004066 Enable HTTP compression.
4067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4068 yes | yes | yes | yes
4069 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004070 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4071 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4072 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4073
4074 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004075 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4076 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4077 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004078
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004079 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004080 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004081
4082 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4083 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4084 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4085 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4086 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004087 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004088
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004089 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4090 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4091 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4092 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4093 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4094 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4095 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004096 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004097
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004098 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004099 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004100 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4101 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4102 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4103 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4104 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004105
4106 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4107 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4108 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4109 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4110 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004111 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4112 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4113 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4114 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4115 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004116 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4117 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004118
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004119 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004120 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4121 "Accept-Encoding" header
4122 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004123 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004124 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4125 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4126 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4127 "multipart"
4128 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4129 header
4130 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4131 and later
4132 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4133 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004134 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004135
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004136 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004137
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004138 Examples :
4139 compression algo gzip
4140 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004141
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004142
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004143cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004144 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4145 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004146 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4149 yes | no | yes | yes
4150 Arguments :
4151 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4152 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4153 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4154 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4155 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4156 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004157 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004158 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4159 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4160
4161 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4162 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4163 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4164 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4165 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4166 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004167 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4168 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004169 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004170 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4171 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004172
4173 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004174 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004175
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004176 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004177 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004178 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004179 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004180 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4181 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4182 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4183 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4184 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4185 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4186 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004187
4188 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4189 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4190 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4191 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4192 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4193 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4194 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4195 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4196 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004197 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004198 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4199 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4200 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004201
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004202 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4203 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4204 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004205 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4206 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4207 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4208 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004209 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4210 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4211 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004212
4213 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4214 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4215 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4216 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4217 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4218 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4219 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4220 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4221 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4222
4223 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4224 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4225 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4226 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4227 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4228 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4229 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4230 persistence cookie in the cache.
4231 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4232
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004233 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4234 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4235 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4236 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4237 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004238 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004239 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4240 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4241 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4242 they logout.
4243
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004244 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4245 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4246 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4247 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4248
4249 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4250 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4251 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4252 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4253 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4254 this attribute.
4255
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004256 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004257 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004258 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4259 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4260 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4261 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4262 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4263 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004264
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004265 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4266 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4267 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4268 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4269 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4270 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4271 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4272 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004273 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004274 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4275 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4276 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4277 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4278 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4279 the site.
4280
4281 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4282 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4283 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4284 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4285 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4286 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4287 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4288 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4289 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4290 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4291 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4292 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4293 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004294 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004295 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4296 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4297
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004298 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4299 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4300 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4301 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4302 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4303 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4304
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004305 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4306 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4307 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4308 repeated.
4309
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004310 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4311 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4312 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4313 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004314
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315 Examples :
4316 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4317 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4318 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004319 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004321 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004323
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004324declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4325 Declares a capture slot.
4326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4327 no | yes | yes | no
4328 Arguments:
4329 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4330
4331 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4332 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4333 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4334 for use in the response.
4335
4336 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004337 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004338 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4339
4340
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004341default-server [param*]
4342 Change default options for a server in a backend
4343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4344 yes | no | yes | yes
4345 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004346 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4347 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4348 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4349 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004350
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004351 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004352 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4353
4354 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004355
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004357default_backend <backend>
4358 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4360 yes | yes | yes | no
4361 Arguments :
4362 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4363
4364 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4365 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4366 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4367 will catch all undetermined requests.
4368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004369 Example :
4370
4371 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4372 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4373 default_backend dynamic
4374
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004375 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004377
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004378description <string>
4379 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4381 no | yes | yes | yes
4382 Arguments : string
4383
4384 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4385 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4386 it describes.
4387 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4388
4389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004390disabled
4391 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4393 yes | yes | yes | yes
4394 Arguments : none
4395
4396 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4397 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4398 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4399 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4400 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4401 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4402 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4403
4404 See also : "enabled"
4405
4406
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004407dispatch <address>:<port>
4408 Set a default server address
4409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4410 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004411 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004412
4413 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4414 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4415 during start-up.
4416
4417 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4418 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4419 possible with normal servers.
4420
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004421 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004422 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4423 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4424 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4425 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4426
4427 See also : "server"
4428
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004429
4430dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4431 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4433 yes | no | yes | yes
4434 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4435
4436 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004437 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004438 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4439 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004440 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004441 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004443enabled
4444 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4446 yes | yes | yes | yes
4447 Arguments : none
4448
4449 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4450 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4451
4452 See also : "disabled"
4453
4454
4455errorfile <code> <file>
4456 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4458 yes | yes | yes | yes
4459 Arguments :
4460 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004461 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004462 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463
4464 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004465 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004466 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004467 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4468 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004469
4470 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4471 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4472 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4473
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004474 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4475
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004476 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4477 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4478 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4479 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4480 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4481 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4482 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4483 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4484 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004485
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004486 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4487 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4488 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004489 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4491
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004492 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004493
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004494 Example :
4495 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004496 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004497 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4498 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4499
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004500
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004501errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4502 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4503 section.
4504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4505 yes | yes | yes | yes
4506 Arguments :
4507 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4508
4509 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004510 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004511 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4512 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004513
4514 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4515 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4516 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4517 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4518 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004519 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004520 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4521
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004522 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4523 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004524
4525 Example :
4526 errorfiles generic
4527 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4528
4529
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004530errorloc <code> <url>
4531errorloc302 <code> <url>
4532 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4534 yes | yes | yes | yes
4535 Arguments :
4536 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004537 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004538 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004539
4540 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4541 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4542 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4543 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004544 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004545
4546 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4547 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4548 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4549
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004550 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4551
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004552 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4553 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4554 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4555 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004556 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004557 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4558 request.
4559
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004560 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004561
4562
4563errorloc303 <code> <url>
4564 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4566 yes | yes | yes | yes
4567 Arguments :
4568 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004569 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004570 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004571
4572 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4573 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4574 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4575 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004576 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004577
4578 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4579 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4580 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4581
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004582 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4583
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004584 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4585 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4586 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4587 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004588 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004589
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004590 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004591
4592
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004593email-alert from <emailaddr>
4594 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004595 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4597 yes | yes | yes | yes
4598
4599 Arguments :
4600
4601 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4602
4603 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4604 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4605
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004606 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004607 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4608 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004609
4610
4611email-alert level <level>
4612 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4613 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4614 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4615 yes | yes | yes | yes
4616
4617 Arguments :
4618
4619 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4620 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4621 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4622
4623 By default level is alert
4624
4625 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4626 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4627 for the proxy.
4628
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004629 Alerts are sent when :
4630
4631 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4632 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4633 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4634 is notice or lower
4635 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4636 and a health check status update occurs
4637
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004638 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4639 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004640 section 3.6 about mailers.
4641
4642
4643email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4644 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4646 yes | yes | yes | yes
4647
4648 Arguments :
4649
4650 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4651
4652 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4653 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4654
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004655 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4656 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004657
4658
4659email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4660 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4661 mailers.
4662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4663 yes | yes | yes | yes
4664
4665 Arguments :
4666
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004667 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004668
4669 By default the systems hostname is used.
4670
4671 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4672 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4673 for the proxy.
4674
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004675 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4676 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004677
4678
4679email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004680 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004681 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4683 yes | yes | yes | yes
4684
4685 Arguments :
4686
4687 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4688
4689 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4690 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4691
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004692 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004693 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4694
4695
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004696force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4697 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4698 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004699 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004700
4701 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4702 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4703 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4704 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4705 marked down for maintenance operations.
4706
4707 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4708 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4709 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4710 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4711 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4712 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4713 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4714 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4715 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4716
4717 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4718 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4719 is used.
4720
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004721 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004722 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004723
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004724
4725filter <name> [param*]
4726 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4727 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4728 no | yes | yes | yes
4729 Arguments :
4730 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4731 referenced in section 9.
4732
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004733 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004734 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004735 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4736 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004737
4738 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4739 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4740
4741 Example:
4742 listen
4743 bind *:80
4744
4745 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4746 filter compression
4747 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4748
4749 compression algo gzip
4750 compression offload
4751
4752 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4753
4754 See also : section 9.
4755
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004756
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004757fullconn <conns>
4758 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4759 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4760 yes | no | yes | yes
4761 Arguments :
4762 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4763 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4764
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004765 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004766 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004767 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004768 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4769 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4770 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4771 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4772 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004773 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004774
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004775 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4776 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004777 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4778 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4779 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004780
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004781 Example :
4782 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4783 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4784 # connections.
4785 backend dynamic
4786 fullconn 10000
4787 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4788 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4789
4790 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4791
4792
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004793grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004794 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4795 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004796 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004797 Arguments :
4798 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4799 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4800 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4801
4802 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4803 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004804 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004805 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4806
4807 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4808 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4809 simplify it.
4810
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004811
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004812hash-balance-factor <factor>
4813 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4815 yes | no | no | yes
4816 Arguments :
4817 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4818 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004819 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004820
4821 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4822 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4823 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4824 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4825 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4826 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4827 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4828
4829 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4830 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4831 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4832 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4833 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4834
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004835 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4836 consistent hashing mechanism.
4837
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004838 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4839
4840
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004841hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004842 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4843 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4844 yes | no | yes | yes
4845 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004846 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4847 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004848
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004849 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4850 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4851 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4852 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4853 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4854 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4855 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4856 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4857 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4858 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004859
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004860 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4861 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4862 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4863 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4864 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4865 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4866 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4867 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4868 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4869 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4870 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4871 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4872 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004873 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4874 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004875
4876 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4877
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004878 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004879 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4880 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4881 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004882 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4883 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4884 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004885
4886 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4887 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004888 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4889 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4890 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4891 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4892
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004893 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4894 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4895 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4896 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4897 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4898 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4899 parameter.
4900
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004901 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4902 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4903 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4904 used on strings.
4905
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004906 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4907
4908 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4909 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4910 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4911 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4912 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4913 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4914 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4915 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4916 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4917 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4918 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4919 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004920
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004921 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4922 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4923 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004924
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004925 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004926
4927
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004928http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4929 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4930 ones).
4931
4932 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 no | yes | yes | yes
4934
4935 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4936 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4937 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4938 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4939 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4940 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4941
4942 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4943 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4944 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4945
4946 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4947 below.
4948
4949 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4950 instance.
4951
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01004952 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
4953 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
4954 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
4955
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004956 Example:
4957 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4958 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4959 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4960
4961http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4962
4963 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4964 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4965 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4966 example, or to pass some internal information.
4967 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4968 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4969 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4970
4971http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4972
4973 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4974 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4975
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004976http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004977
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00004978 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
4979 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
4980 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
4981 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
4982 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004983
4984http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4985 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4986
4987 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4988
4989 Example:
4990 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4991
4992 # applied to:
4993 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4994
4995 # outputs:
4996 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4997
4998 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4999
5000http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5001 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5002
5003 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5004
5005 Example:
5006 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5007
5008 # applied to:
5009 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5010
5011 # outputs:
5012 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5013
5014http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5015
5016 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5017 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5018 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5019
5020http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5021 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5022
5023 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5024 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5025 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5026 fallback.
5027
5028 Example:
5029 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5030 http-response set-status 431
5031 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5032 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5033
5034http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5035
5036 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5037 inline.
5038
5039 Arguments:
5040 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5041 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5042 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5043 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5044 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5045 (request and response)
5046 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5047 processing
5048 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5049 processing
5050 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5051 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5052 and '_'.
5053
5054 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5055 followed by some converters.
5056
5057 Example:
5058 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5059
5060http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5061
5062 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5063 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5064 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5065 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5066 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005067 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005068 processing.
5069
5070 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5071 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005072 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005073 rules evaluation.
5074
5075http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5076
5077 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5078 details about <var-name>.
5079
5080 Example:
5081 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5082
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005083
5084http-check comment <string>
5085 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5086 it fails.
5087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5088 yes | no | yes | yes
5089
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005090 Arguments :
5091 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5092 rule fails.
5093
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005094 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5095 user-friendly error reporting.
5096
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005097 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005098 "http-check expect".
5099
5100
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005101http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5102 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005103 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005104 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5106 yes | no | yes | yes
5107
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005108 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005109 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5110
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005111 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005112 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005113
5114 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5115 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5116 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5117 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5118
5119 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5120
5121 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5122
5123 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5124
5125 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5126
5127 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5128
5129 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5130 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5131 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5132 is used.
5133
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005134 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5135 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5136 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5137 haproxy -vv.
5138
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005139 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5140
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005141 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5142 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5143 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5144 different ports or with different servers.
5145
5146 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5147 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5148 the port with a "http-check connect".
5149
5150 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5151 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5152 do.
5153
5154 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5155 unset-var or comment rules.
5156
5157 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005158 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5159 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5160 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5161 option httpchk
5162
5163 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005164 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005165 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005166 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005167 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005168 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005169
5170 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5171
5172 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005173
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005174
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005175http-check disable-on-404
5176 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005178 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005179 Arguments : none
5180
5181 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5182 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5183 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5184 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5185 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5186 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5187 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5188 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005189 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5190 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005191 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5192 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5193 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005194
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005195 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005196
5197
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005198http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005199 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5200 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5201 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005202 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005204 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005205
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005206 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005207 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5208
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005209 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5210 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5211 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5212 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5213 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5214 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5215 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5216 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5217 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5218 result is always conclusive.
5219
5220 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5221 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5222 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005223 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5224 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005225 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5226 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005227 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5228 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5229 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005230
5231 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5232 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005233 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5234 supported :
5235 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5236 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005237 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5238 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5239 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5240 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5241 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005242
5243 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5244 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005245 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5246 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5247 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5248 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005249 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5250
5251 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5252 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5253 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5254 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5255
5256 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5257 informational message reported in logs if an error
5258 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5259 log-format string.
5260
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005261 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005262 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5263 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005264 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5265 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5266 details on the supported keywords.
5267
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005268 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5269 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5270 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5271 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005272
5273 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5274 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5275 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5276 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5277 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5278
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005279 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5280 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5281 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5282 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5283 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5284 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5285 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005286
5287 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005288 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005289 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5290 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5291 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5292 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5293
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005294 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5295 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005296 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5297 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5298 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5299 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5300 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5301 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5302 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5303 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005304 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5305 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5306 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5307 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5308 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5309 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5310 insensitive on the header names.
5311
5312 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5313 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5314 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5315 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5316 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5317 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005318
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005319 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005320 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005321 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5322 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5323 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5324 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5325 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005326 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005327 trace).
5328
5329 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005330 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005331 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5332 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5333 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5334 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5335 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005336 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005337
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005338 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5339 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5340 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5341 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5342 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5343 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5344
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005345 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005346 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005347 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5348 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5349 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5350 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5351 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5352 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5353
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005354 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5355 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5356 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5357 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5358 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005359
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005360 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5361 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5362
5363 Examples :
5364 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005365 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005366
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005367 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5368 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5369
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005370 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005371 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005372
5373 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005374 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005375
5376 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005377 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005378
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005379 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005380 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005381
5382
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005383http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005384 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5385 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005386 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5387 health checks.
5388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5389 yes | no | yes | yes
5390 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005391 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5392
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005393 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5394 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5395 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5396 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5397 to invent non-standard ones.
5398
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005399 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5400 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5401 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5402 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5403
5404 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5405 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5406 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5407 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005408
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005409 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005410 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005411 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005412 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5413 to add it.
5414
5415 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5416 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5417 to the log-format rules.
5418
5419 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5420 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5421 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005422
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005423 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5424 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5425 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5426 request.
5427
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005428 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5429 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5430 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005431 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5432 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5433 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5434 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005435 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005436
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005437 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005438 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5439 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005440
5441 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5442 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5443 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5444 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5445 configured request authority.
5446
5447 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5448 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005449
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005450 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005451
5452
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005453http-check send-state
5454 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5456 yes | no | yes | yes
5457 Arguments : none
5458
5459 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5460 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5461 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5462 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5463 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5464
5465 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5466 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5467 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5468 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5469 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005470 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5471 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5472 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5473
5474 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5475 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5476 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5477
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005478 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5479 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5480 checked in multiple backends.
5481
5482 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5483 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5484
5485 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5486 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5487 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5488 one fails.
5489
5490 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5491 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5492 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5493
5494 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5495 server's queue.
5496
5497 Example of a header received by the application server :
5498 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5499 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5500
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005501 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5502 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005503
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005504
5505http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005506 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5508 yes | no | yes | yes
5509
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005510 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005511 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5512 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5513 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5514 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5515 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5516 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5517 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5518 and '-'.
5519
5520 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5521
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005522 Examples :
5523 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005524
5525
5526http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005527 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5529 yes | no | yes | yes
5530
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005531 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005532 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5533 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5534 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5535 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5536 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5537 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5538 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5539 and '-'.
5540
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005541 Examples :
5542 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005544
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005545http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5546 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5547 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5548 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5549 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5551 yes | yes | yes | yes
5552 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005553 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005554 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005555 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005556 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005557
5558 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5559 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5560 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5561 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5562
5563 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5564 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5565 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5566 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5567
5568 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5569 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5570 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5571 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5572 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5573 chroot is performed.
5574
5575 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5576 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5577 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5578 considered.
5579
5580 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5581 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5582 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5583 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5584 considered as a raw string.
5585
5586 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5587 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5588 "content-type".
5589
5590 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5591 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5592 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5593 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5594 evaluated as a log-format string.
5595
5596 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5597 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5598 argument to "content-type".
5599
5600 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5601 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5602 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5603 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5604
5605 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5606 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5607 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5608 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5609 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5610 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5611 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5612 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5613
5614 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5615 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5616 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5617
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005618 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5619 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5620 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5621 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5622 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5623
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005624 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5625 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5626
5627
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005628http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005629 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5630
5631 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5632 no | yes | yes | yes
5633
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005634 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5635 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5636 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5637 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5638 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005640 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5641 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005643 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005644
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005645 Example:
5646 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5647 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5648 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005650 http-request allow if nagios
5651 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5652 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5653 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005655 Example:
5656 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5657 acl add path /addacl
5658 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005659
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005660 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005662 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5663 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005665 Example:
5666 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5667 acl setmap path /setmap
5668 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005669
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005670 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005672 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5673 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005675 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5676 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005678http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005679
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005680 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5681 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5682 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5683 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5684 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5685 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5686 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5687 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005689http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005691 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5692 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5693 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5694 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5695 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5696 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5697 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5698 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005699
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005700http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005701
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005702 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5703 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005704
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005705
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005706http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005708 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5709 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5710 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5711 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5712 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005713
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005714 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5715 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5716 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5717 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5718 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5719 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5720 instead.
5721
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005722 Example:
5723 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5724 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005725
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005726http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005727
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005728 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005730http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5731 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005732
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005733 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5734 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5735 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5736 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5737 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5738 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5739 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5740 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5741 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005743 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5744 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5745 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005746 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5747
5748 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5749 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5750 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5751 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005753http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005754
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005755 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5756 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5757 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5758 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5759 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5760 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005761
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005762http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005763
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005764 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5765 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5766 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5767 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5768 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005769
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005770http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005772 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5773 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5774 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5775 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5776 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5777 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005778
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005779http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5780http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5781 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5782 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5783 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5784 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005785
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005786 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5787 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5788 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005789 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005790 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5791 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5792 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005793 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005794 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005795
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005796http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5797 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5798 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5799 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5800
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005801http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5802
5803 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5804 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5805 pointed by <resolvers>.
5806 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5807 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5808 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5809 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5810 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5811 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5812 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5813 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5814 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5815 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5816 to 0.0.0.0.
5817
5818 Example:
5819 resolvers mydns
5820 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5821 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5822 timeout retry 1s
5823 hold valid 10s
5824 hold nx 3s
5825 hold other 3s
5826 hold obsolete 0s
5827 accepted_payload_size 8192
5828
5829 frontend fe
5830 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5831 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5832 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5833
5834 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5835 # which mean DNS resolution error
5836 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5837
5838 default_backend be
5839
5840 backend b_503
5841 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5842 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5843 # 503 error page to end users
5844
5845 backend be
5846 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5847 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5848 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5849 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5850 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5851
5852 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5853 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5854
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005855http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5856
5857 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5858 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5859 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5860 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005861 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5862 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005863
5864 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5865
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005866http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005867
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005868 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5869 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5870 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5871 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5872 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005873
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005874http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005875
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005876 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5877 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5878 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5879 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005881http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5882 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005883
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005884 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005885 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5886 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5887 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5888 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5889 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005890
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005891 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5892 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5893 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5894 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5895 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005896
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005897 Example:
5898 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5899
5900 # applied to:
5901 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5902
5903 # outputs:
5904 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5905
5906 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005907
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005908 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5909
5910 # applied to:
5911 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005912
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005913 # outputs:
5914 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005915
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005916http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5917 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5918
5919 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5920 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02005921 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
5922 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
5923 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005924
5925 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5926 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5927 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5928
5929 Example:
5930 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5931 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5932
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005933 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5934 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5935 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5936 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5937
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02005938http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5939 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5940
5941 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
5942 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
5943 query-string are replaced.
5944
5945 Example:
5946 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5947 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5948
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005949http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5950 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5951
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005952 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5953 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5954 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5955 against.
5956
5957 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5958 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5959 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005960
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005961 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5962 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5963 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5964 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5965 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5966 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5967 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5968 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5969 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005970 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5971 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005972
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005973 Example:
5974 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5975 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005976
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005977 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5978 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5981 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005982
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005983 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5984 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5985 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5986 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005987
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005988 Example:
5989 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005990
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005991 # applied to:
5992 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005993
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005994 # outputs:
5995 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005996
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005997http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5998 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5999 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006000 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006001 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6002
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006003 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006004 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6005 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006006 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006007 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006008 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006009 are followed to create the response :
6010
6011 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6012 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6013 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6014 ignored.
6015
6016 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6017 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006018 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006019 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6020 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006021
6022 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6023 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6024 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006025 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6026 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006027
6028 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6029 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6030 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006031 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006032 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006033 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006034
6035 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6036 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6037 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6038 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6039 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6040 as a raw content.
6041
6042 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6043 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6044 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6045 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6046 considered as a raw string.
6047
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006048 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006049 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6050 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6051 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6052
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006053 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6054 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006055 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006056
6057 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6058
6059 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006060 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006061 if { path /ping }
6062
6063 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6064 if { path /favicon.ico }
6065
6066 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6067 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6068 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6071http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006073 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6074 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6075 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006076
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006077http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6078 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006079
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006080 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6081 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6082 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6083 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006085http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006087 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6088 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6089 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6090 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6091 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006092
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006093 Arguments:
6094 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6095 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 Example:
6098 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6099 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006101 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6102 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006104http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006106 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6107 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6108 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110 Arguments:
6111 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6112 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006114 Example:
6115 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6116 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006117
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006118 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6119 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6120 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006121
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006122http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6125 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6126 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6127 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6128 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006129
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006130 Example:
6131 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6132 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6133 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6134 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6135 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6136 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6137 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6138 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6139 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006140
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006141http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006143 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6144 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6145 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6146 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6147 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006148
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006149http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6150 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006151
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006152 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6153 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6154 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6155 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6156 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6157 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6158 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6159 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6160 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006162http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006164 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6165 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6166 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6167 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6168 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6169 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6170 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006172http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006174 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6175 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6176 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006177
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006178http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006179
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006180 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6181 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6182 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6183 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6184 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6185 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6186 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6187 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006189http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006190
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006191 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6192 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6193 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6194 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6195 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6196 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006198 Example :
6199 # prepend the host name before the path
6200 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006201
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006202http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6203
6204 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6205 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6206 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6207
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006208http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006209
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006210 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6211 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6212 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6213 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6214 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006215
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006216http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006218 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6219 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6220 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6221 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6222 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6223 values have higher priority.
6224 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6225 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6226 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6227 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6228 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006229
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006230http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006231
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006232 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6233 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6234 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6235 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6236 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6237 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6238 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006239
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006240 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006241
6242 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006243 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6244 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006245
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006246http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6247 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6248 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6249 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006250 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6251 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006252
6253 Arguments :
6254 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6255 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006256
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006257 See also "option forwardfor".
6258
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006259 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006260 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6261 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6262
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006263 # After the masking this will track connections
6264 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6265 http-request track-sc0 src
6266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006267 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6268 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6269
6270http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6271
6272 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6273 expression.
6274
6275 Arguments:
6276 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6277 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006278
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006279 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006280 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6281 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6282
6283 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6284 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6285 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6286
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006287http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6288 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6289
6290 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6291 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6292 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6293 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6294 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6295
6296 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6297 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6298 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6299 results.
6300
6301 Example:
6302 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6303 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006305http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6306
6307 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6308 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6309 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6310 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6311 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6312 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6313 information from the request.
6314
6315 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6316
6317http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6318
6319 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6320 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6321 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6322 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6323 path and the query string.
6324 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6325
6326http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6327
6328 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6329 inline.
6330
6331 Arguments:
6332 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6333 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6334 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6335 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6336 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6337 (request and response)
6338 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6339 processing
6340 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6341 processing
6342 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6343 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6344 and '_'.
6345
6346 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6347 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006348
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006349 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006350 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006352http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6353 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006354
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006355 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6356 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6357 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6358 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6359 agent name must be used.
6360
6361 Arguments:
6362 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6363
6364 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6365 configuration.
6366
6367http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6368
6369 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6370 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6371 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6372 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6373 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6374 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6375 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6376 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6377 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6378 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6379 action.
6380 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6381 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6382 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6383 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6384 you fully understand how it works.
6385
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006386http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6387
6388 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6389 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6390 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6391 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6392 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006393 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006394 processing.
6395
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006396 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006397 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6398 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6399 rules evaluation.
6400
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006401http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6402http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6403 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6404 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6405 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6406 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006407
6408 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6409 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6410 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006411 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6412 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6413 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6414 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6415 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6416 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6417 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6418 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6419 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6420 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006421 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006422 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6423 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6424 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6425 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6426 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006427
6428http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6429http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6430http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6431
6432 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6433 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6434 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6435 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006436 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006437 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6438 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6439 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6440 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6441 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6442 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6443 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6444
6445 Arguments :
6446 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6447 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6448 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6449 select which table entry to update the counters.
6450
6451 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6452 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6453 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6454 that table until the session ends.
6455
6456 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6457 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6458 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6459 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6460 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6461 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6462 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6463 useful information.
6464
6465 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6466 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6467 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6468 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6469 checks that make use of it.
6470
6471http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6472
6473 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006474
6475 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006476 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006477
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006478http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6479
6480 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6481 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6482 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6483 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6484 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6485 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6486
6487 Arguments :
6488 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6489
6490 Example:
6491 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6492
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006493http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6496 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6497 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006498
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006499
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006500http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006501 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6502
6503 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6504 no | yes | yes | yes
6505
6506 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6507 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6508 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6509 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6510 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6511 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6512
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006513 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6514 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006515
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006516 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006517
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006518 Example:
6519 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006520
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006521 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006522
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006523 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6524 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006525
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006526 Example:
6527 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006528
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006529 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006530
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006531 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6532 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006533
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006534 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6535 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006536
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006537http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006538
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006539 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6540 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6541 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6542 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6543 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6544 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6545 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6546 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006547
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006548http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006549
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006550 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6551 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6552 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6553 example, or to pass some internal information.
6554 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6555 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6556 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006557
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006558http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006559
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006560 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6561 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006562
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006563http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006564
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006565 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006566
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006567http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006568
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006569 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6570 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6571 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6572 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6573 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6574 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6575 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006576
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006577 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6578 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6579 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6580 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6581 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006582
6583 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6584 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6585 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6586 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006587
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006588http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006589
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006590 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6591 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6592 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6593 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6594 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6595 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006596
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006597http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006598
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006599 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6600 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6601 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6602 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6603 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006604
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006605http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006606
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006607 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6608 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6609 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6610 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6611 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6612 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006613
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006614http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6615http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6616 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6617 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6618 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6619 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006620
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006621 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6622 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6623 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006624 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006625 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6626 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6627 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006628 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006629 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006630
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006631http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006632
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006633 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6634 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6635 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6636 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6637 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6638 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006639
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006640http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6641 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006642
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006643 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6644 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006645
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006646 Example:
6647 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006648
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006649 # applied to:
6650 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006651
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006652 # outputs:
6653 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006654
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006655 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006656
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006657http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6658 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006659
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006660 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006661 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006662
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006663 Example:
6664 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006666 # applied to:
6667 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006668
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006669 # outputs:
6670 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006671
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006672http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6673 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6674 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006675 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006676 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6677
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006678 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006679 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6680 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006681 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006682 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006683 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006684 are followed to create the response :
6685
6686 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6687 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6688 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6689 ignored.
6690
6691 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6692 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006693 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006694 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6695 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006696
6697 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6698 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6699 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006700 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6701 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006702
6703 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6704 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6705 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006706 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006707 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006708 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006709
6710 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6711 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6712 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6713 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6714 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6715 as a raw content.
6716
6717 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6718 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6719 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6720 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6721 considered as a raw string.
6722
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006723 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6724 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6725 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6726 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6727
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006728 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6729 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006730 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006731
6732 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6733
6734 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006735 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006736 if { status eq 404 }
6737
6738 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6739 string "This is the end !" \
6740 if { status eq 500 }
6741
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006742http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6743http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006745 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6746 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6747 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006748
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006749http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6750 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006751
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006752 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6753 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6754 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6755 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006757http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006759 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6760 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6761 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6762 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6763 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006765 Arguments:
6766 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006768 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6769 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006770
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006771http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006773 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6774 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6775 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006776
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006777http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6778
6779 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6780 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6781 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6782 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6783 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6784
6785http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6786
6787 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6788 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6789 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6790 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6791 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6792 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6793 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6794 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6795 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6796
6797http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6798
6799 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6800 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6801 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6802 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6803 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6804 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6805 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6806
6807http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6808
6809 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6810 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6811 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6812 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6813 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6814 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6815 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6816 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6817
6818http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6819 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6820
6821 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6822 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6823 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6824 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006825
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006826 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006827 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6828 http-response set-status 431
6829 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6830 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006831
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006832http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006834 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6835 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6836 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6837 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6838 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6839 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6840 based on some information from the request.
6841
6842 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6843
6844http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6845
6846 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6847 inline.
6848
6849 Arguments:
6850 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6851 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6852 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6853 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6854 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6855 (request and response)
6856 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6857 processing
6858 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6859 processing
6860 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6861 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6862 and '_'.
6863
6864 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6865 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006866
6867 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006868 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006870http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006871
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006872 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6873 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6874 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6875 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6876 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6877 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6878 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6879 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6880 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6881 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6882 action.
6883 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6884 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6885 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6886 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6887 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006888
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006889http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6890
6891 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6892 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6893 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6894 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6895 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006896 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006897 processing.
6898
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006899 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006900 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006901 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006902 rules evaluation.
6903
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006904http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6905http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6906http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006907
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006908 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6909 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6910 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6911 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6912 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6913 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6914
6915http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6916
6917 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6918 about <var-name>.
6919
6920 Example:
6921 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6922
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006923
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006924http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6925 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6926
6927 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6928 yes | no | yes | yes
6929
6930 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006931 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6932 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6933 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006934
6935 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6936
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006937 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6938 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6939 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6940 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6941 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6942 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6943 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6944 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6945 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6946 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006947
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006948 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6949 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6950 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6951 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6952 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6953 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6954 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02006955 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
6956 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
6957 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
6958 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
6959 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
6960 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006961
6962 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6963 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6964 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6965 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6966 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6967 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6968 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6969 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006970 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006971 downsides of rare connection failures.
6972
6973 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6974 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6975 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6976 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6977 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6978 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006979 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006980 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6981 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6982 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6983 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6984 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6985
6986 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01006987 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
6988 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
6989 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
6990 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006991
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01006992 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
6993 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006994
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006995 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006996
6997 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6998 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6999 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7000
7001 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7002
7003
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007004http-send-name-header [<header>]
7005 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007006 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7007 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007008 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007009 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7010
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007011 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7012 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7013 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7014 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7015 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7016 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7017 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7018 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7019 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7020 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7021 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7022 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7023 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7024 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7025 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7026 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007027
7028 See also : "server"
7029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007030id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007031 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7033 no | yes | yes | yes
7034 Arguments : none
7035
7036 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7037 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7038 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007039
7040
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007041ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7042 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007044 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007045
7046 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7047 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7048 and running).
7049
7050 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7051 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7052 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007053 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007054 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7055
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007056 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7057 "unless" condition is met.
7058
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007059 Example:
7060 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7061 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7062 ignore-persist if url_static
7063
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007064 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7065
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007066load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7067 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7068 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7069 yes | no | yes | yes
7070
7071 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7072 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7073 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007074 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007075 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7076 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7077 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7078 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7079
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007080 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007081 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007082 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007083
7084 Arguments:
7085 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7086 named "server-state-file".
7087
7088 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7089 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7090 name is used as a file name.
7091
7092 none don't load any stat for this backend
7093
7094 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007095 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7096 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7097 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007098 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007099 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007100
7101 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7102 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7103
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007104 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007105
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007106 global
7107 stats socket /tmp/socket
7108 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007109
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007110 defaults
7111 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007112
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007113 backend bk
7114 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7115 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007116
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007117
7118 Then one can run :
7119
7120 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7121
7122 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7123
7124 1
7125 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7126 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7127 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7128
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007129 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007130
7131 global
7132 stats socket /tmp/socket
7133 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7134
7135 defaults
7136 load-server-state-from-file local
7137
7138 backend bk
7139 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7140 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7141
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007142
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007143 Then one can run :
7144
7145 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7146
7147 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7148
7149 1
7150 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7151 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7152 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7153
7154 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7155 "show servers state"
7156
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007157
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007158log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007159log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007160 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007161no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007162 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7164 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007165
7166 Prefix :
7167 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7168 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7169 prefix does not allow arguments.
7170
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007171 Arguments :
7172 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7173 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7174 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7175 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7176 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7177 parameter.
7178
7179 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7180 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7181
7182 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7183 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7184 standard syslog port).
7185
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007186 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7187 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7188 standard syslog port).
7189
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007190 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7191 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7192 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007193 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007194
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007195 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7196 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7197 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7198 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7199 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7200 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7201 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7202 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7203 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7204 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7205 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7206 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7207 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7208 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7209 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7210 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007211 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7212 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007213
7214 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7215 and "fd@2", see above.
7216
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007217 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7218 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7219 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7220 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7221 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7222 having the logs instantly available.
7223
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007224 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7225 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007226
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007227 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7228 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7229 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7230 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7231 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7232 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7233 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7234 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7235 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7236 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007237 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007238
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007239 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7240 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7241 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7242 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7243 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7244
7245 <sample_size>
7246 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7247 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7248 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7249 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7250 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7251
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007252 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7253 one of the following :
7254
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007255 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7256 field is stripped. This is the default.
7257 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7258 rfc3164.
7259
7260 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007261 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7262
7263 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7264 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7265
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007266 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7267 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7268 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7269 designed to be used with a local log server.
7270
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007271 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7272 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7273 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7274 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7275 systemd logger consumes.
7276
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007277 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7278 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7279 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7280 used with a local log server.
7281
7282 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7283 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7284 designed to be used with a local log server.
7285
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007286 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7287 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7288 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7289 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7290
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007291 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7292
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007293 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7294 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7295 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7296
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007297 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7298 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7299 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7300 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007301
7302 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7303 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7304 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007305 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7306 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7307 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7308 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7309 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007310
7311 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7312
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007313 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7314 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7315 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007316
7317 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7318 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7319 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7320 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7321
7322 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7323 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007324
7325 Example :
7326 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007327 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7328 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7329 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007330 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
7331 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007332 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007333
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007334
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007335log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007336 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7338 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007339
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007340 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7341 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7342 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7343 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7344 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007345
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007346 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7347 "option httplog" directives.
7348
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007349log-format-sd <string>
7350 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7351 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7352 yes | yes | yes | no
7353
7354 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7355 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7356 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7357 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7358 which covers the log format string in depth.
7359
7360 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7361 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7362
7363 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7364 log format to "rfc5424".
7365
7366 Example :
7367 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7368
7369
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007370log-tag <string>
7371 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7372 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7373 yes | yes | yes | yes
7374
7375 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7376 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7377 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7378 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7379 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7380 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7381 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7382 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7383 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007384
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007385max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7386 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7387 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7388 yes | no | yes | yes
7389
7390 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7391 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7392 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7393 servers.
7394
7395 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7396 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7397 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7398 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7399 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007400 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007401 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7402 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7403 picking a different server.
7404
7405 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7406 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7407 even if they have to be queued.
7408
7409 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7410 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7411
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007412max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7413 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7414 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7415 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007416
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007417maxconn <conns>
7418 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7420 yes | yes | yes | no
7421 Arguments :
7422 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7423 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7424 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7425 closes.
7426
7427 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7428 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7429 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7430 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007431 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7432 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7433 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7434 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007435
7436 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7437 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7438 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7439
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007440 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7441 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007442
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007443 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7444
7445
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007446mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007447 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7449 yes | yes | yes | yes
7450 Arguments :
7451 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7452 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7453 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7454 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7455
7456 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7457 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7458 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7459 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7460 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7461
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007462 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7463 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7464 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007465
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007466 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007467 defaults http_instances
7468 mode http
7469
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007470
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007471monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007472 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7474 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007475 Arguments :
7476 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7477 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007478 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007479 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7480 backend and its backup.
7481
7482 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7483 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7484 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7485 servers in a list of backends.
7486
7487 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7488 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7489 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7490 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7491 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7492 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7493 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007494 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7495 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007496
7497 Example:
7498 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007499 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007500 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7501 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7502 monitor-uri /site_alive
7503 monitor fail if site_dead
7504
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007505 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007506
7507
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007508monitor-uri <uri>
7509 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7511 yes | yes | yes | no
7512 Arguments :
7513 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7514 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7515
7516 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7517 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7518 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7519 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7520 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7521 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7522 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7523 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7524
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007525 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007526 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7527 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7528 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7529 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7530 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7531 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007532
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007533 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7534 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7535 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7536 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7537
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007538 Example :
7539 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7540 frontend www
7541 mode http
7542 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7543
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007544 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007545
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007546
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007547option abortonclose
7548no option abortonclose
7549 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7550 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 yes | no | yes | yes
7552 Arguments : none
7553
7554 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7555 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7556 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7557 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007558 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007559 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7560 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7561 encountered while delivering the response.
7562
7563 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7564 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7565 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7566 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7567 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7568 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007569 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007570 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007571 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007572 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7573 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7574 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7575
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007576 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7577 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007578 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7579 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7580 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7581 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7582 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7583 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007584 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007585
7586 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7587 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7588
7589 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7590
7591
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007592option accept-invalid-http-request
7593no option accept-invalid-http-request
7594 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7596 yes | yes | yes | no
7597 Arguments : none
7598
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007599 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007600 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007601 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007602 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7603 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7604 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7605 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7606 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007607 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7608 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7609 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7610 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007611 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007612 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007613 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7614 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7615 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007616
7617 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7618 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7619 been confirmed.
7620
7621 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7622 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007623 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7624 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007625 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7626
7627 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7628 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7629
7630 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7631 stats socket.
7632
7633
7634option accept-invalid-http-response
7635no option accept-invalid-http-response
7636 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7638 yes | no | yes | yes
7639 Arguments : none
7640
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007641 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007642 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007643 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007644 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7645 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7646 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7647 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7648 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007649 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7650 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7651 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007652
7653 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7654 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7655 been confirmed.
7656
7657 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7658 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7659 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7660 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7661
7662 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7663 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7664
7665 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7666 stats socket.
7667
7668
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007669option allbackups
7670no option allbackups
7671 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7673 yes | no | yes | yes
7674 Arguments : none
7675
7676 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7677 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7678 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7679 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7680 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7681 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7682 order between the backup servers anymore.
7683
7684 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7685 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7686
7687 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7688 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7689
7690
7691option checkcache
7692no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007693 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7695 yes | no | yes | yes
7696 Arguments : none
7697
7698 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7699 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007700 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007701 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7702 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007703 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007704
7705 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007706 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007707 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007708 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7709 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007710 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007711 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007712 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7713 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007714 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007715 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7716 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007717 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007718 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7719 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7720 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7721 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7722 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7723 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7724 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7725 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7726 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7727
7728 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007729 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7730 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7731 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7732 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007733
7734 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7735 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007736 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007737 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007738
7739 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7740 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7741
7742
7743option clitcpka
7744no option clitcpka
7745 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7747 yes | yes | yes | no
7748 Arguments : none
7749
7750 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7751 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007752 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007753 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7754
7755 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7756 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7757 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7758 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7759
7760 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7761 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7762 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7763 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7764 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7765
7766 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7767
7768 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7769 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7770 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7771
7772 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7773 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7774
7775 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7776
7777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007778option contstats
7779 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7781 yes | yes | yes | no
7782 Arguments : none
7783
7784 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7785 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7786 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7787 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007788 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7789 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7790 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7791 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7792 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007793
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007794option disable-h2-upgrade
7795no option disable-h2-upgrade
7796 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7797 connection.
7798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7799 yes | yes | yes | no
7800 Arguments : none
7801
7802 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7803 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7804 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7805 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7806 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7807 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7808 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7809 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7810
7811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007813
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007814option dontlog-normal
7815no option dontlog-normal
7816 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7818 yes | yes | yes | no
7819 Arguments : none
7820
7821 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7822 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7823 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7824 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7825 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7826 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7827 logged.
7828
7829 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7830 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7831 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7832
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007833 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007834 logging.
7835
7836
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007837option dontlognull
7838no option dontlognull
7839 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7841 yes | yes | yes | no
7842 Arguments : none
7843
7844 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7845 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7846 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7847 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7848 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7849 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007850 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7851 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7852 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007853
7854 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007855 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007856 would not be logged.
7857
7858 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7859 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7860
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007861 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007862 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007863
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007864
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007865option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007866 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7868 yes | yes | yes | yes
7869 Arguments :
7870 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7871 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007872 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007873 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007874
7875 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7876 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7877 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7878 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7879 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7880 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7881 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007882 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7883 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7884 possible that the client has already brought one.
7885
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007886 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007887 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007888 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007889 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007890 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007891 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007892
7893 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7894 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7895 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7896 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7897 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7898 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7899 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7900
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007901 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7902 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7903 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7904 are under the control of the end-user.
7905
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007906 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007907 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7908 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007909 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7910 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7911 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007912
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007913 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007914 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7915 frontend www
7916 mode http
7917 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7918
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007919 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7920 backend www
7921 mode http
7922 option forwardfor header X-Client
7923
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007924 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007925 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007926
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007927
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007928option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7929no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7930 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7932 yes | yes | yes | no
7933 Arguments : none
7934
7935 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7936 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7937 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7938 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7939 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7940 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7941 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7942
7943 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7944 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7945 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7946 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7947 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7948 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7949 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7950 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7951 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7952 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7953
7954 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7955
7956 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7957 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7958
7959 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7960 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7961
7962
7963option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7964no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7965 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7967 yes | no | yes | yes
7968 Arguments : none
7969
7970 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7971 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7972 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7973 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7974 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7975 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7976 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7977
7978 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7979 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7980 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7981 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7982 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7983 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7984 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7985 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7986 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7987 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7988
7989 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7990
7991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7993
7994 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7995 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7996
7997
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007998option http-buffer-request
7999no option http-buffer-request
8000 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8002 yes | yes | yes | yes
8003 Arguments : none
8004
8005 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8006 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8007 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8008 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8009 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8010 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008011 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8012 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8013 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8014 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008015
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01008016 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008017
8018
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008019option http-ignore-probes
8020no option http-ignore-probes
8021 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8023 yes | yes | yes | no
8024 Arguments : none
8025
8026 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8027 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8028 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8029 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8030 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8031 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8032 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8033 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8034 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008035 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8036 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008037 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8038
8039 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8040 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8041 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8042 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8043 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8044 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8045 are often the only way to detect them.
8046
8047 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8048 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8049
8050 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8051
8052
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008053option http-keep-alive
8054no option http-keep-alive
8055 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8056 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8057 yes | yes | yes | yes
8058 Arguments : none
8059
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008060 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8061 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008062 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8063 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008064 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8065 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8066 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008067
8068 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8069 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008070 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8071 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8072 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8073 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8074 situations where this option may be useful :
8075
8076 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008077 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008078
8079 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8080 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8081
8082 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8083 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8084 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8085 request.
8086
8087 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8088 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008089 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8090 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8091 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008092
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008093 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8094 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8095 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8096 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8097 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8098 not set.
8099
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008100 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8101 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8102 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008103
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008104 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008105 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008106 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008107
8108
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008109option http-no-delay
8110no option http-no-delay
8111 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8113 yes | yes | yes | yes
8114 Arguments : none
8115
8116 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8117 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8118 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8119 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8120 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8121 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8122 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8123 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8124 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8125 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8126 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8127 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8128 affected.
8129
8130 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8131 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8132 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8133 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8134 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8135 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8136 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8137 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8138 latency environments.
8139
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008140 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8141
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008142
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008143option http-pretend-keepalive
8144no option http-pretend-keepalive
8145 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008147 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008148 Arguments : none
8149
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008150 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008151 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8152 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8153 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8154 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8155 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8156 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8157 consider the response complete.
8158
8159 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8160 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8161 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8162 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008163 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008164 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8165
8166 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8167 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8168 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8169 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8170 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8171 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8172 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8173
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008174 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8175 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8176 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8177 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8178 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8179 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008180
8181 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8182 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8183
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008184 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008185 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008186
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008187
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008188option http-server-close
8189no option http-server-close
8190 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8192 yes | yes | yes | yes
8193 Arguments : none
8194
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008195 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8196 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8197 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8198 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008199 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8200 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8201 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8202 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8203 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8204 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8205 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8206 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8207 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8208 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8209 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008210
8211 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8212 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8213 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8214 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008215 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8216 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008217
8218 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8219 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008220 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8221 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8222 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008223
8224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8226
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008227 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8228 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008229
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008230option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008231no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008232 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8234 yes | yes | yes | no
8235 Arguments : none
8236
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008237 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008238 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8239 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8240 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8241 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8242 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8243 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8244
8245 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8246 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008247 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8248 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8249 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008250
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008251 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8252 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8253 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8254 front of an existing proxy.
8255
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008256 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8257
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008258 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008259
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008260option httpchk
8261option httpchk <uri>
8262option httpchk <method> <uri>
8263option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008264 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8266 yes | no | yes | yes
8267 Arguments :
8268 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8269 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8270 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8271 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8272 ones.
8273
8274 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8275 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8276 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8277
8278 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8279 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8280 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008281 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008282
8283 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8284 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8285 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8286 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8287 the lack of any response.
8288
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008289 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8290 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8291 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8292 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8293
8294 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8295 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8296 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008297
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008298 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8299 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008300 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008301 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008302 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008303
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008304 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8305 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8306 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8307 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8308
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008309 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008310 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8311 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8312 backend https_relay
8313 mode tcp
8314 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8315 http-check send hdr Host www
8316 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008317
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008318 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8319 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8320 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008321
8322
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008323option httpclose
8324no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008325 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8327 yes | yes | yes | yes
8328 Arguments : none
8329
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008330 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8331 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8332 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8333 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008334 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008335
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008336 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8337 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008338 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008339 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8340 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008341
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008342 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8343 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8344 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008345
8346 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8347 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008348 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8349 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8350 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008351
8352 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8353 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8354
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008355 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008356
8357
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008358option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008359 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008361 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008362 Arguments :
8363 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8364 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8365 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008366 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008367 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008368
8369 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8370 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8371 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8372 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8373 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8374 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8375 ports.
8376
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008377 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8378 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008379
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008380 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008382 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008383
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008384
8385option http_proxy
8386no option http_proxy
8387 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8389 yes | yes | yes | yes
8390 Arguments : none
8391
8392 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8393 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8394 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8395 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8396 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8397
8398 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8399 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008400 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8401 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008402
8403 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8404 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8405
8406 Example :
8407 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8408 backend direct_forward
8409 option httpclose
8410 option http_proxy
8411
8412 See also : "option httpclose"
8413
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008414
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008415option independent-streams
8416no option independent-streams
8417 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8419 yes | yes | yes | yes
8420 Arguments : none
8421
8422 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8423 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8424 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8425 receive data or not.
8426
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008427 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008428 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8429 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8430 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8431 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8432 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8433 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8434 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8435 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8436 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8437 socket buffers.
8438
8439 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8440 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8441 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8442 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8443 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8444
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008445 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008446
8447
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008448option ldap-check
8449 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8451 yes | no | yes | yes
8452 Arguments : none
8453
8454 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8455 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8456 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8457 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8458
8459 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8460 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8461
8462 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8463 configure it.
8464
8465 Example :
8466 option ldap-check
8467
8468 See also : "option httpchk"
8469
8470
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008471option external-check
8472 Use external processes for server health checks
8473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8474 yes | no | yes | yes
8475
8476 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8477 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8478 command".
8479
8480 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8481
8482 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8483
8484
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008485option log-health-checks
8486no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008487 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8489 yes | no | yes | yes
8490 Arguments : none
8491
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008492 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8493 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8494 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008495
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008496 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8497 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8498 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8499 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8500 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8501
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008502 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008503 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008504
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008505 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8506 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8507 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008508
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008509
8510option log-separate-errors
8511no option log-separate-errors
8512 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8514 yes | yes | yes | no
8515 Arguments : none
8516
8517 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8518 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8519 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8520 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8521 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8522 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8523 provides very important information.
8524
8525 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8526 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8527 error logs.
8528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008529 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008530 logging.
8531
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008532
8533option logasap
8534no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008535 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8537 yes | yes | yes | no
8538 Arguments : none
8539
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008540 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8541 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8542 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8543 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8544
8545 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8546 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8547 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8548 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8549 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008550 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008551 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8552 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8553 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8554 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008555 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008556
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008557 Examples :
8558 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8559 mode http
8560 option httplog
8561 option logasap
8562 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8563
8564 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8565 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8566 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8567 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8568
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008569 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008570 logging.
8571
8572
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008573option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008574 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8576 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008577 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008578 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8579 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008580 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8581 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008582
8583 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8584 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008585 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008586 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8587 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8588 in the MySQL table, like this :
8589
8590 USE mysql;
8591 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8592 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8593
8594 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008595 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008596 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8597 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8598 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8599 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8600 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8601 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8602 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8603
8604 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8605 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008606
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008607 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008608
8609 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8610 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8611 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8612 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008613 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8614 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008615
8616 See also: "option httpchk"
8617
8618
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008619option nolinger
8620no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008621 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008622 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8623 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008624 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008625
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008626 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008627 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8628 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8629 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8630 connections.
8631
8632 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8633 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008634 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8635 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8636 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8637 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8638 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8639 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8640 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8641 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8642 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8643 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8644 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8645 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8646 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008647
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008648 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8649 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8650 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8651 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8652 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008653
8654 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8655 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008656 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008657 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008658 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008659
8660 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8661 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8662
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008663 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8664 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008665
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008666option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8667 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8669 yes | yes | yes | yes
8670 Arguments :
8671 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8672 matching <network>
8673 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8674 header name.
8675
8676 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8677 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8678 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8679 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8680 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8681 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8682 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8683 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8684 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8685 possible that the client has already brought one.
8686
8687 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8688 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8689 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8690 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8691 header and requires different one.
8692
8693 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8694 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8695 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8696 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8697 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8698 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8699 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8700
8701 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8702 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8703 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8704 both are defined.
8705
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008706 Examples :
8707 # Original Destination address
8708 frontend www
8709 mode http
8710 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8711
8712 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8713 backend www
8714 mode http
8715 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8716
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008717 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008718
8719
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008720option persist
8721no option persist
8722 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8723 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8724 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008725 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008726
8727 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8728 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8729 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8730 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8731 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8732 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8733 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8734 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8735 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8736 redirected to another valid server.
8737
8738 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8739 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8740
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008741 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008742
8743
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008744option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8745 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8747 yes | no | yes | yes
8748 Arguments :
8749 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8750 PostgreSQL server.
8751
8752 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8753 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8754 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8755 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8756
8757 See also: "option httpchk"
8758
8759
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008760option prefer-last-server
8761no option prefer-last-server
8762 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8764 yes | no | yes | yes
8765 Arguments : none
8766
8767 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8768 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8769 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8770 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8771 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8772 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8773 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8774 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8775 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008776 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8777 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008778 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8779 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8780 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008781 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8782 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8783 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008784
8785 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8786 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8787
8788 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8789
8790
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008791option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008792option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008793no option redispatch
8794 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8796 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008797 Arguments :
8798 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8799 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8800 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008801 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008802 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008803 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008804 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8805 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8806 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8807
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008808
8809 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8810 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8811 be able to access the service anymore.
8812
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008813 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8814 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008815
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008816 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8817 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8818 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8819 following order:
8820
8821 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8822
8823 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8824 list, or
8825
8826 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8827
8828 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8829 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8830
8831 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8832 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8833 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8834 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8835
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008836 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008837 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8838 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008839
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008840 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8841 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8842
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008843 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008844
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008845
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008846option redis-check
8847 Use redis health checks for server testing
8848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8849 yes | no | yes | yes
8850 Arguments : none
8851
8852 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8853 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8854 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8855 find the "+PONG" response message.
8856
8857 Example :
8858 option redis-check
8859
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008860 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008861
8862
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008863option smtpchk
8864option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8865 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8867 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008868 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008869 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008870 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008871 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8872
8873 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8874 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8875 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8876
8877 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8878 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8879 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8880 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8881 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8882 dead server.
8883
8884 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8885 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008886 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008887 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8888
8889 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8890 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8891 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8892 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008893 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008894
8895 Example :
8896 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8897
8898 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008901option socket-stats
8902no option socket-stats
8903
8904 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8906 yes | yes | yes | no
8907
8908 Arguments : none
8909
8910
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008911option splice-auto
8912no option splice-auto
8913 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8915 yes | yes | yes | yes
8916 Arguments : none
8917
8918 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8919 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008920 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008921 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008922 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008923 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8924 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8925 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8926 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8927
8928 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8929 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8930 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8931 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8932 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8933 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8934 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8935 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8936 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8937 keyword.
8938
8939 Example :
8940 option splice-auto
8941
8942 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8943 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8944
8945 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8946 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8947
8948
8949option splice-request
8950no option splice-request
8951 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8953 yes | yes | yes | yes
8954 Arguments : none
8955
8956 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008957 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008958 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8959 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8960 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8961 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8962
8963 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8964
8965 Example :
8966 option splice-request
8967
8968 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8969 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8970
8971 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8972 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8973
8974
8975option splice-response
8976no option splice-response
8977 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8979 yes | yes | yes | yes
8980 Arguments : none
8981
8982 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008983 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008984 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8985 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8986 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8987 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8988
8989 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8990
8991 Example :
8992 option splice-response
8993
8994 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8995 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8996
8997 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8998 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8999
9000
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009001option spop-check
9002 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9004 no | no | no | yes
9005 Arguments : none
9006
9007 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9008 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9009 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9010 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9011
9012 Example :
9013 option spop-check
9014
9015 See also : "option httpchk"
9016
9017
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009018option srvtcpka
9019no option srvtcpka
9020 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9022 yes | no | yes | yes
9023 Arguments : none
9024
9025 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9026 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009027 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009028 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9029
9030 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9031 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9032 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9033 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9034
9035 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9036 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9037 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9038 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9039 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9040
9041 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9042
9043 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9044 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9045 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9046
9047 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9048 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9049
9050 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9051
9052
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009053option ssl-hello-chk
9054 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9056 yes | no | yes | yes
9057 Arguments : none
9058
9059 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9060 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9061 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9062 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9063 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9064 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9065 hello message.
9066
9067 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9068 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9069 messages, which is appreciable.
9070
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009071 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9072 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9073 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009074
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009075 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9076
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009077
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009078option tcp-check
9079 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9081 yes | no | yes | yes
9082
9083 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9084 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9085
9086 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9087 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9088 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9089
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009090 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009091 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9092 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9093 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9094 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9095 only.
9096
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009097 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009098 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9099 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9100 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9101 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9102
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009103 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009104 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9105 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009106 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009107 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9108 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9109 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9110 the respective protocols.
9111 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009112 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009113
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009114 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009115
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009116 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9117 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9118 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9119 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009120
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009121 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9122 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9123 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009124
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009125
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009126 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009127 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009128 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009129 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009130
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009131 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009132 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009133 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009134
9135 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9136 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009137 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009138 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009139 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009140 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009141 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009142 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009143 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9144 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009145 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009146 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9147 tcp-check expect string +OK
9148
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009149 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009150 (send many headers before analyzing)
9151 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009152 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009153 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9154 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9155 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9156 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009157 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009158
9159
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009160 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009161
9162
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009163option tcp-smart-accept
9164no option tcp-smart-accept
9165 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9167 yes | yes | yes | no
9168 Arguments : none
9169
9170 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9171 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9172 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9173 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9174 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9175 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9176
9177 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9178 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9179 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9180 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9181
9182 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9183 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9184 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009185 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009186
9187 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9188 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9189 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9190
9191 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9192 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9193 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9194
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009195 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9196
9197
9198option tcp-smart-connect
9199no option tcp-smart-connect
9200 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9202 yes | no | yes | yes
9203 Arguments : none
9204
9205 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9206 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9207 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9208 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9209 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9210
9211 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9212 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9213 complex.
9214
9215 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9216 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9217 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9218
9219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9221
9222 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9223
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009224
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009225option tcpka
9226 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9228 yes | yes | yes | yes
9229 Arguments : none
9230
9231 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9232 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009233 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009234 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9235
9236 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9237 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9238 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9239 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9240
9241 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9242 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9243 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9244 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9245 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9246
9247 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9248
9249 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9250 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9251 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9252 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9253 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9254 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9255 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9256 backends.
9257
9258 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9259
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009260
9261option tcplog
9262 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009264 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009265 Arguments : none
9266
9267 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9268 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9269 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9270 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9271 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9272 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9273 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9274 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9275
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009276 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9277
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009278 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009279
9280
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009281option transparent
9282no option transparent
9283 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009285 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009286 Arguments : none
9287
9288 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9289 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9290 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9291 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9292 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9293 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9294 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9295 appropriate server.
9296
9297 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9298 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9299
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009300 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009301 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009302
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009303
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009304external-check command <command>
9305 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9307 yes | no | yes | yes
9308
9309 Arguments :
9310 <command> is the external command to run
9311
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009312 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9313
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009314 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009315
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009316 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9317 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9318 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9319 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9320 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9321 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009322
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009323 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9324
9325 Environment variables :
9326 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9327 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9328
9329 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9330
9331 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9332
9333 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9334 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9335 for a UNIX socket).
9336
9337 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9338
9339 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9340
9341 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9342
9343 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9344
9345 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9346
9347 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9348 socket).
9349
9350 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9351 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9352
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009353 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9354
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009355 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9356 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9357 failed.
9358
9359 Example :
9360 external-check command /bin/true
9361
9362 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9363
9364
9365external-check path <path>
9366 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9368 yes | no | yes | yes
9369
9370 Arguments :
9371 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9372
9373 The default path is "".
9374
9375 Example :
9376 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9377
9378 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9379 "external-check command"
9380
9381
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009382persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009383persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009384 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 yes | no | yes | yes
9387 Arguments :
9388 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009389 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9390 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009391
9392 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9393 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009394 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009395 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9396 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9397 forwarded to this server.
9398
9399 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9400 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9401 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009402 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009403 a single "listen" section.
9404
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009405 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9406 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9407 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9408
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009409 Example :
9410 listen tse-farm
9411 bind :3389
9412 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9413 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9414 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9415 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9416 persist rdp-cookie
9417 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009418 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009419 balance rdp-cookie
9420 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9421 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9422
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009423 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9424 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009425
9426
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009427rate-limit sessions <rate>
9428 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9430 yes | yes | yes | no
9431 Arguments :
9432 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9433 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9434
9435 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9436 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9437 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9438 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9439 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9440 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9441
9442 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9443 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9444 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9445 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9446
9447 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9448 listen smtp
9449 mode tcp
9450 bind :25
9451 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009452 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009453
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009454 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9455 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9456 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009457
9458 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9459
9460
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009461redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9462redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9463redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009464 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9466 no | yes | yes | yes
9467
9468 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009469 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009470
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009471 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009472 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009473 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9474 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9475 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009476
9477 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9478 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9479 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9480 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9481 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009482 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9483 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9484 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9485 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009486
9487 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9488 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9489 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9490 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9491 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9492 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009493 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009494 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009495 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9496 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9497 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009498
9499 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009500 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9501 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9502 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009503 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009504 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9505 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9506 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9507 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009508
9509 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009510 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009511
9512 - "drop-query"
9513 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9514 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9515 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9516 with a location-type redirect.
9517
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009518 - "append-slash"
9519 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9520 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9521 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9522 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9523
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009524 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9525 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9526 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9527 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9528 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9529 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9530 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9531
9532 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9533 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9534 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9535 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9536 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9537 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9538 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009539
9540 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9541 acl clear dst_port 80
9542 acl secure dst_port 8080
9543 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009544 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009545 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009546 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9547
9548 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009549 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9550 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9551 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009552 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009553
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009554 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9555 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9556 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9557
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009558 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009559 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009560
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009561 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009562 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9563 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9564 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009566 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009567
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009568
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009569retries <value>
9570 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9571 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9572 yes | no | yes | yes
9573 Arguments :
9574 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9575 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9576 default value is 3.
9577
9578 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9579 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9580 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9581
9582 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009583 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9584 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009585
9586 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9587 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9588
9589 See also : "option redispatch"
9590
9591
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009592retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009593 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9594 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9595 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9597 yes | no | yes | yes
9598 Arguments :
9599 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9600 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9601 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9602 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9603
9604 none never retry
9605
9606 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9607 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9608
9609 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9610 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9611 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9612 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9613 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9614 processing the request.
9615
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009616 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9617 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9618 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9619 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9620 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9621 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9622 overflow attack for example).
9623
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009624 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9625 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9626 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9627 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9628 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9629 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9630 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9631 amplify denial of service attacks.
9632
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009633 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9634 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9635 considered to be safe to retry.
9636
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009637 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9638 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9639 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9640 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9641 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009642
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009643 all-retryable-errors
9644 retry request for any error that are considered
9645 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9646 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9647 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9648
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009649 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9650 not cumulative.
9651
9652 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9653 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9654 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9655 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9656
9657 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9658 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9659 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9660 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9661 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9662 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9663 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9664 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9665 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9666 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9667 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9668 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9669
9670 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9671 should not use this directive.
9672
9673 The default is "conn-failure".
9674
9675 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9676
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009677server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009678 Declare a server in a backend
9679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9680 no | no | yes | yes
9681 Arguments :
9682 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009683 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009684 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009685
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009686 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9687 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9688 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9689 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009690 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9691 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9692 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9693 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9694 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009695 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9696 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9697 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9698 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9699 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9700 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9701 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009702 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009703 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9704 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9705 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9706 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9707 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9708 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009709 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9710 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009711 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9712 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009713
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009714 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009715 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9716 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9717 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9718 adding this value to the client's port.
9719
9720 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9721 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009722 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009723
9724 Examples :
9725 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9726 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009727 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009728 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9729 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9730 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009731
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009732 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9733 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9734 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9735 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9736 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9737
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009738 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9739 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009740
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009741server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009742 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009743 this backend.
9744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9745 no | no | yes | yes
9746
9747 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9748 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9749 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9750 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9751 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009752
9753 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9754 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9755
9756 global
9757 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9758
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009759 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009760 load-server-state-from-file
9761
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009762 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009763 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009764
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009765server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9766 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9767 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9769 no | no | yes | yes
9770
9771 Arguments:
9772 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9773
9774 <num | range>
9775 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9776 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9777 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9778 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9779
9780 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9781
9782 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9783
9784 <params*>
9785 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9786 keyword.
9787
9788 Examples:
9789 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9790 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9791 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9792
9793 # or
9794 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9795
9796 # would be equivalent to:
9797 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9798 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9799 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9800
9801
9802
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009803source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009804source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009805source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009806 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9808 yes | no | yes | yes
9809 Arguments :
9810 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9811 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009812
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009813 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009814 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9815 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9816 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9817 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9818 supported prefixes are :
9819 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9820 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9821 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009822 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009823 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9824 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009825
9826 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9827 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009828 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9829 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9830 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009831
9832 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9833 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9834 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9835 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9836 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9837 <addr>.
9838
9839 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9840 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9841 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9842 port.
9843
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009844 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9845 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9846 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9847 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009848 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009849 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9850 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9851 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9852 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9853 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9854 HTTP header.
9855
9856 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9857 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009858 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009859 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9860 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9861 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9862 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9863 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9864 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9865 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9866
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009867 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9868 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9869 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9870 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9871 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9872 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9873
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009874 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9875 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9876 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9877 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9878
9879 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9880 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9881 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9882 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9883 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9884 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9885
9886 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9887 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9888 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9889 there are two methods :
9890
9891 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9892 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9893 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9894 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9895 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9896 of the client ranges may be used.
9897
9898 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9899 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9900 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9901 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9902 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9903 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9904 same session.
9905
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009906 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9907 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9908 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009909 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009910
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009911 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9912
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009913 Examples :
9914 backend private
9915 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9916 source 192.168.1.200
9917
9918 backend transparent_ssl1
9919 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9920 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9921
9922 backend transparent_ssl2
9923 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9924 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9925 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9926
9927 backend transparent_ssl3
9928 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9929 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9930 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9931
9932 backend transparent_smtp
9933 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9934 # with Tproxy version 4.
9935 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9936
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009937 backend transparent_http
9938 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9939 # proxy.
9940 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009942 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009943 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9944
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009945
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009946srvtcpka-cnt <count>
9947 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
9948 the connection on the server side.
9949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9950 yes | no | yes | yes
9951 Arguments :
9952 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
9953
9954 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
9955 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009956 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9957 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009958
9959 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9960
9961
9962srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
9963 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
9964 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
9965 server side.
9966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9967 yes | no | yes | yes
9968 Arguments :
9969 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
9970 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
9971 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
9972 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
9973
9974 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
9975 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009976 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9977 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009978
9979 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
9980
9981
9982srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
9983 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
9984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9985 yes | no | yes | yes
9986 Arguments :
9987 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
9988 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
9989 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
9990 document.
9991
9992 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
9993 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02009994 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
9995 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09009996
9997 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
9998
9999
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010000stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10001 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010003 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010004
10005 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10006 matched.
10007
10008 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10009 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10010
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010011 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10012 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010013 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010014
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010015 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10016 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10017 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10018 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010019
10020 Example :
10021 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10022 backend stats_localhost
10023 stats enable
10024 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10025
10026 Example :
10027 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10028 backend stats_auth
10029 stats enable
10030 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10031 stats admin if TRUE
10032
10033 Example :
10034 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10035 userlist stats-auth
10036 group admin users admin
10037 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10038 group readonly users haproxy
10039 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10040
10041 backend stats_auth
10042 stats enable
10043 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10044 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10045 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10046 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10047
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010048 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10049 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10050 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010051
10052
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010053stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10054 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010056 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010057 Arguments :
10058 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10059
10060 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10061
10062 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10063 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10064 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10065 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10066 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10067 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10068
10069 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10070 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10071 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010072 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010073
10074 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10075 report using "stats scope".
10076
10077 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10078 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10079 unobvious parameters.
10080
10081 Example :
10082 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10083 backend public_www
10084 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10085 stats enable
10086 stats hide-version
10087 stats scope .
10088 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010089 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010090 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10091 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10092
10093 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10094 backend private_monitoring
10095 stats enable
10096 stats uri /admin?stats
10097 stats refresh 5s
10098
10099 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10100
10101
10102stats enable
10103 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010105 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010106 Arguments : none
10107
10108 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10109 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10110 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10111 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10112 - stats auth : no authentication
10113 - stats scope : no restriction
10114
10115 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10116 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10117 unobvious parameters.
10118
10119 Example :
10120 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10121 backend public_www
10122 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10123 stats enable
10124 stats hide-version
10125 stats scope .
10126 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010127 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010128 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10129 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10130
10131 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10132 backend private_monitoring
10133 stats enable
10134 stats uri /admin?stats
10135 stats refresh 5s
10136
10137 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10138
10139
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010140stats hide-version
10141 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010143 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010144 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010145
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010146 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10147 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10148 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10149 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10150 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10151 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010152
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010153 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10154 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10155 unobvious parameters.
10156
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010157 Example :
10158 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10159 backend public_www
10160 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010161 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010162 stats hide-version
10163 stats scope .
10164 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010165 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010166 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10167 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010168
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010169 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10170 backend private_monitoring
10171 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010172 stats uri /admin?stats
10173 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010174
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010175 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010176
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010177
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010178stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10179 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10180 Access control for statistics
10181
10182 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10183 no | no | yes | yes
10184
10185 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10186 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10187 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10188 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10189 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10190 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10191
10192 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10193 instance.
10194
10195 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10196 about ACL usage.
10197
10198
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010199stats realm <realm>
10200 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10201 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010202 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010203 Arguments :
10204 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10205 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10206 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10207
10208 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10209 using a backslash ('\').
10210
10211 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10212 only related to authentication.
10213
10214 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10215 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10216 unobvious parameters.
10217
10218 Example :
10219 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10220 backend public_www
10221 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10222 stats enable
10223 stats hide-version
10224 stats scope .
10225 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010226 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010227 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10228 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10229
10230 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10231 backend private_monitoring
10232 stats enable
10233 stats uri /admin?stats
10234 stats refresh 5s
10235
10236 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10237
10238
10239stats refresh <delay>
10240 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010242 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010243 Arguments :
10244 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10245 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10246 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10247 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10248 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10249 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10250
10251 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10252 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10253 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010254 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010255
10256 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10257 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10258 unobvious parameters.
10259
10260 Example :
10261 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10262 backend public_www
10263 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10264 stats enable
10265 stats hide-version
10266 stats scope .
10267 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010268 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010269 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10270 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10271
10272 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10273 backend private_monitoring
10274 stats enable
10275 stats uri /admin?stats
10276 stats refresh 5s
10277
10278 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10279
10280
10281stats scope { <name> | "." }
10282 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10283 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010284 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010285 Arguments :
10286 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10287 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10288 section in which the statement appears.
10289
10290 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10291 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10292 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10293 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10294 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10295 exists.
10296
10297 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10298 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10299 unobvious parameters.
10300
10301 Example :
10302 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10303 backend public_www
10304 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10305 stats enable
10306 stats hide-version
10307 stats scope .
10308 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010309 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010310 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10311 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10312
10313 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10314 backend private_monitoring
10315 stats enable
10316 stats uri /admin?stats
10317 stats refresh 5s
10318
10319 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10320
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010321
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010322stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010323 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010325 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010326
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010327 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010328 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10329
10330 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10331 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10332
10333 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10334 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010335 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010336
10337 Example :
10338 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10339 backend private_monitoring
10340 stats enable
10341 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10342 stats uri /admin?stats
10343 stats refresh 5s
10344
10345 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10346 global section.
10347
10348
10349stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010350 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10352 yes | yes | yes | yes
10353 Arguments : none
10354
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010355 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010356 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10357 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10358 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10359 - IP (socket, server)
10360 - cookie (backend, server)
10361
10362 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10363 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010364 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010365
10366 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10367
10368
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010369stats show-modules
10370 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10372 yes | yes | yes | yes
10373 Arguments : none
10374
10375 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10376 values as a tooltip.
10377
10378 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10379 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10380 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10381
10382 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10383
10384
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010385stats show-node [ <name> ]
10386 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010388 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010389 Arguments:
10390 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10391 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10392
10393 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10394 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010395 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010396
10397 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10398 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10399 unobvious parameters.
10400
10401 Example:
10402 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10403 backend private_monitoring
10404 stats enable
10405 stats show-node Europe-1
10406 stats uri /admin?stats
10407 stats refresh 5s
10408
10409 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10410 section.
10411
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010412
10413stats uri <prefix>
10414 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010416 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010417 Arguments :
10418 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10419 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10420 query string.
10421
10422 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10423 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10424 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10425 possible to reach it in the application.
10426
10427 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010428 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010429 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10430 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10431 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10432 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10433
10434 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10435 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10436 an address or a port to statistics only.
10437
10438 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10439 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10440 unobvious parameters.
10441
10442 Example :
10443 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10444 backend public_www
10445 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10446 stats enable
10447 stats hide-version
10448 stats scope .
10449 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010450 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010451 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10452 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10453
10454 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10455 backend private_monitoring
10456 stats enable
10457 stats uri /admin?stats
10458 stats refresh 5s
10459
10460 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10461
10462
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010463stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10464 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010465 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010466 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010467
10468 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010469 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010470 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010471 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010472 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10473
10474 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10475 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10476 the "stick-table" statement.
10477
10478 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10479 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10480 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10481 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10482 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10483
10484 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10485 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10486 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10487 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10488 transformation rules.
10489
10490 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10491 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10492 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10493 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10494 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10495 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10496 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10497
10498 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10499 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10500 ACL based conditions.
10501
10502 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10503 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10504 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10505 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10506
10507 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10508 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10509 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10510 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10511
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010512 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10513 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010514 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010515
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010516 Example :
10517 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10518 # last 30 minutes
10519 backend pop
10520 mode tcp
10521 balance roundrobin
10522 stick store-request src
10523 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10524 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10525 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10526
10527 backend smtp
10528 mode tcp
10529 balance roundrobin
10530 stick match src table pop
10531 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10532 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10533
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010534 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010535 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010536
10537
10538stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10539 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10541 no | no | yes | yes
10542
10543 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10544 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10545 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10546 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10547
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010548 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10549 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010550 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010551
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010552 Examples :
10553 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010554 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010555
10556 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10557 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10558 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10559
10560
10561 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10562 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10563 backend http
10564 mode http
10565 balance roundrobin
10566 stick on src table https
10567 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10568 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10569 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10570
10571 backend https
10572 mode tcp
10573 balance roundrobin
10574 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10575 stick on src
10576 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10577 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10578
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010579 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010580
10581
10582stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10583 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10585 no | no | yes | yes
10586
10587 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010588 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010589 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010590 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010591 server is selected.
10592
10593 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10594 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10595 the "stick-table" statement.
10596
10597 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10598 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10599 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10600 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10601 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10602 address.
10603
10604 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10605 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10606 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10607 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10608 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10609 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10610 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10611 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10612 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10613 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10614
10615 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10616 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10617 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10618 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10619 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10620 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10621 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10622
10623 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10624 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10625 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10626 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10627
10628 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10629 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10630 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10631 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10632 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10633 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010634 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10635 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10636 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10637 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10638 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10639 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010640
10641 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10642 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10643 the request.
10644
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010645 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10646 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010647 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010648
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010649 Example :
10650 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10651 # last 30 minutes
10652 backend pop
10653 mode tcp
10654 balance roundrobin
10655 stick store-request src
10656 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10657 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10658 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10659
10660 backend smtp
10661 mode tcp
10662 balance roundrobin
10663 stick match src table pop
10664 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10665 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10666
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010667 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010668 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010669
10670
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010671stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010672 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010673 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010674 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010676 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010677
10678 Arguments :
10679 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10680 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10681 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10682 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10683
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010684 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10685 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10686 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10687 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10688
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010689 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10690 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10691 instance.
10692
10693 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10694 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10695 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10696 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10697 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10698 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010699 to 32 characters.
10700
10701 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10702 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10703 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010704 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010705 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10706 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010707
10708 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010709 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10710 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010711 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10712 increase.
10713
10714 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010715 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10716 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10717 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010718
10719 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10720 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10721 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10722 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010723 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010724 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10725 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10726 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10727 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10728 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10729 parameter (see below).
10730
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010731 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10732 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10733 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10734 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10735 soft restart.
10736
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010737 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10738 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010739
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010740 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10741 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10742 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10743 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010744 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010745 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010746 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10747 if not expiration delay is specified.
10748
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010749 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
10750 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
10751 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
10752 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
10753 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
10754 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
10755 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
10756 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
10757 token.
10758
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010759 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10760 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10761 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10762 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010763 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10764 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10765 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10766 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10767 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10768 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10769 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10770 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10771 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10772 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10773 types and their arguments.
10774
10775 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10776 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10777 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10778 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10779
10780 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10781 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10782 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010783 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010784
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010785 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10786 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10787 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010788 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010789 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010790 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010791
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010792 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10793 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10794 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10795 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10796
10797 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10798 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10799 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10800 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10801 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10802 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10803
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010804 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10805 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10806 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10807 they were received.
10808
10809 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10810 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10811 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10812 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10813 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10814
10815 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10816 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10817 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10818 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10819 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10820
10821 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10822 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10823 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10824
10825 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10826 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10827 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10828 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10829 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10830
10831 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10832 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10833 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10834 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10835 the client side.
10836
10837 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10838 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10839 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10840 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10841 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10842 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10843 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10844
10845 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10846 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10847 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10848 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10849 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10850 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010851 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010852
10853 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10854 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10855 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10856 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10857 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10858 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10859
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010010860 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10861 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
10862 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10863 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
10864 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
10865
10866 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10867 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10868 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10869 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10870 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
10871 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10872
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010873 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010874 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010875 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10876 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10877
10878 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10879 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10880 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10881 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10882 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10883 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10884 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10885 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10886 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10887 recommended for better fairness.
10888
10889 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010890 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010891 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10892 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10893
10894 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10895 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10896 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10897 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10898 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10899 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10900 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10901 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10902 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10903 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010904
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010905 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10906 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010907 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10908 reference it.
10909
10910 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10911 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010912 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10913 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10914 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010915
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010916 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10917 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10918 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10919 something that can be ignored.
10920
10921 Example:
10922 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10923 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10924 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10925 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10926
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010927 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010928 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010929
10930
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010931stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010932 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10934 no | no | yes | yes
10935
10936 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010937 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010938 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010939 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010940 server is selected.
10941
10942 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10943 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10944 the "stick-table" statement.
10945
10946 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10947 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10948 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10949 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10950
10951 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10952 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10953 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10954 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10955 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10956 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010957 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010958 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10959 rules.
10960
10961 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10962 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10963 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10964 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10965 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10966 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10967 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10968
10969 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10970 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10971 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10972 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10973
10974 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10975 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10976 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10977 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10978 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10979 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010980 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10981 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10982 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10983 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10984 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10985 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10986 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10987 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10988 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010989
10990 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10991
10992 Example :
10993 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10994 backend https
10995 mode tcp
10996 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010997 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010998 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010999
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011000 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11001 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11002
11003 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11004 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11005 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11006
11007 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11008 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011009
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011010 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11011 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11012 # at offset 44.
11013
11014 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11015 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11016
11017 # Learn on response if server hello.
11018 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011019
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011020 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11021 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11022
11023 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11024 extraction.
11025
11026
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011027tcp-check comment <string>
11028 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11029 it fails.
11030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11031 yes | no | yes | yes
11032
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011033 Arguments :
11034 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11035 rule fails.
11036
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011037 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11038 user-friendly error reporting.
11039
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011040 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11041 "tcp-check expect".
11042
11043
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011044tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11045 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011046 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011047 Opens a new connection
11048 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011049 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011050
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011051 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011052 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11053
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011054 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011055 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011056
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011057 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011058 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11059 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011060 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011061
11062 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011063
11064 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11065
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011066 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11067
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011068 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11069
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011070 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11071
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011072 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11073 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11074 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11075 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11076
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011077 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11078 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11079 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11080 haproxy -vv.
11081
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011082 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011083
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011084 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11085 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11086 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11087
11088 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11089 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11090 of the sequence.
11091
11092 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11093 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11094 do.
11095
11096 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11097 unset-var or comment rules.
11098
11099 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011100 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11101 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11102 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11103 option tcp-check
11104 tcp-check connect
11105 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11106 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11107 tcp-check send \r\n
11108 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11109 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11110 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11111 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11112 tcp-check send \r\n
11113 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11114 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11115
11116 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11117 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011118 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011119 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11120 tcp-check connect port 143
11121 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11122 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11123
11124 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11125
11126
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011127tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011128 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011129 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011130 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011131 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011132 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011133 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011134
11135 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011136 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11137
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011138 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11139 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11140 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11141 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11142 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11143 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11144 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11145 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11146 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11147 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11148
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011149 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011150 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11151 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011152 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11153 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11154 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11155
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011156 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11157 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11158 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011159 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11160 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011161 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11162 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011163 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11164 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011165 By default "L7OK" is used.
11166
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011167 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11168 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011169 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11170 supported :
11171 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11172 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011173 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11174 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11175 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11176 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11177 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011178
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011179 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011180 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011181 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11182 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11183 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11184 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011185 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11186
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011187 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11188 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11189 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11190 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11191
11192 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11193 informational message reported in logs if an error
11194 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11195 log-format string.
11196
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011197 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11198 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11199 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11200 followed by some converters.
11201
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011202 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11203 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11204 with the usual backslash ('\').
11205 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011206 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011207 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11208 used upper or lower case.
11209
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011210 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11211
11212 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11213 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11214 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11215 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11216 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11217 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11218 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11219 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11220
11221 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11222 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11223 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11224 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11225 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11226 expression.
11227
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011228 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11229 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11230 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11231 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11232 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11233 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11234
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011235 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11236 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11237 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11238 this exact hexadecimal string.
11239 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11240
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011241 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11242 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11243 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11244 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11245 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11246 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11247 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11248 size.
11249
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011250 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11251 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11252 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11253 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11254 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11255 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11256 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11257 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11258 in a binary string before matching the response's
11259 buffer.
11260
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011261 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011262 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011263 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11264 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11265 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11266 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11267 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11268 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11269 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11270 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11271 the null character.
11272
11273 Examples :
11274 # perform a POP check
11275 option tcp-check
11276 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11277
11278 # perform an IMAP check
11279 option tcp-check
11280 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11281
11282 # look for the redis master server
11283 option tcp-check
11284 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011285 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011286 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11287 tcp-check expect string role:master
11288 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11289 tcp-check expect string +OK
11290
11291
11292 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011293 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011294
11295
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011296tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11297tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11298 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11299 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011300 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011301 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011302
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011303 Arguments :
11304 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11305
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011306 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11307 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011308
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011309 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11310 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011311
11312 Examples :
11313 # look for the redis master server
11314 option tcp-check
11315 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11316 tcp-check expect string role:master
11317
11318 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011319 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011320
11321
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011322tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11323tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11324 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11325 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011326 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011327 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011328
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011329 Arguments :
11330 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011331
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011332 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11333 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011334
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011335 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11336 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11337 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011338
11339 Examples :
11340 # redis check in binary
11341 option tcp-check
11342 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11343 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11344
11345
11346 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011347 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011348
11349
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011350tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011351 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011352 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011353 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011354
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011355 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011356 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11357 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11358 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11359 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11360 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11361 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11362 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11363 and '-'.
11364
11365 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11366
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011367 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011368 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11369
11370
11371tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011372 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011373 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011374 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011375
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011376 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011377 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11378 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11379 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11380 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11381 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11382 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11383 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11384 and '-'.
11385
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011386 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011387 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11388
11389
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011390tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11391 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11393 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011394 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011395 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11396 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011397
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011398 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011399
11400 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11401 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011402 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11403 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11404 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11405 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11406 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11407 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011408
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011409 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11410 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11411 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11412 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011413
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011414 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011415 - accept :
11416 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11417 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11418 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011419
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011420 - reject :
11421 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11422 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11423 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11424 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11425 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11426 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11427 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11428 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11429 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11430 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11431 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011432 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011433
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011434 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11435 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11436 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11437 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11438 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11439 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11440 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11441 hosts.
11442
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011443 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11444 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11445 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11446 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11447 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11448 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11449 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11450 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11451
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011452 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11453 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11454 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11455 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11456 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11457 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11458 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11459 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11460 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011461 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11462 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011463
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011464 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011465 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011466 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11467 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11468 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011469 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011470 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011471 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11472 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11473 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11474 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11475 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11476 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11477 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011478
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011479 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011480 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011481 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011482 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011483 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11484 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11485 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011487 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11488 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11489 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11490 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011492 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11493 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11494 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11495 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11496 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011497 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11498 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11499 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11500 layer7 information is extracted.
11501
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011502 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11503 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11504 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11505 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11506 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011507
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011508 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11509 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11510 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11511 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11512
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011513 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11514 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11515 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11516 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11517
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011518 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11519 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11520 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11521 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11522 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011523
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011524 - set-src <expr> :
11525 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11526 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11527 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011528 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011529
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011530 Arguments:
11531 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11532 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011533
11534 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011535 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11536
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011537 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11538 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011539
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011540 - set-src-port <expr> :
11541 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11542 expression.
11543
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011544 Arguments:
11545 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11546 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011547
11548 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011549 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11550
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011551 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11552 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11553 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011554
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011555 - set-dst <expr> :
11556 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11557 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11558 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11559 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11560 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11561
11562 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11563 followed by some converters.
11564
11565 Example:
11566
11567 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11568 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11569
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011570 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11571 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11572
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011573 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11574 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11575 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11576 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11577
11578
11579 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11580 followed by some converters.
11581
11582 Example:
11583
11584 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11585
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011586 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11587 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11588 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11589
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011590 - "silent-drop" :
11591 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011592 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011593 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11594 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11595 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11596 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11597 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011598 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11599 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011600 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11601 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011602 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011603 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11604 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11605 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11606 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11607
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011608 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11609 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11610 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011611
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011612 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11613 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11614 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011615
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011616 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011617 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011618 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011619
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011620 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11621 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11622 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011623
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011624 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011625 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11626 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011627
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011628 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11629
11630 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11631
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011632 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11633
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011634 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011635
11636
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011637tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11638 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011639 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011640 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011641 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011642 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11643 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011644
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011645 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011646
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011647 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011648 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11649 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
11650 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
11651 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011652
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011653 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11654 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11655 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11656 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011657 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11658 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11659 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11660 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11661 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11662 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011663 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011664 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011665
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011666 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11667 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11668 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11669 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011670
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011671 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011672 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011673 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011674 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11675 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011676 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011677 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011678 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011679 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011680 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011681 - set-dst <expr>
11682 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011683 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011684 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011685 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011686 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011687 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011688
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011689 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11690 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011691 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11692 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011693
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011694 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11695 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11696 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11697 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11698 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11699 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011700
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011701 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011702 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11703 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011704
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011705 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11706 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11707 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11708 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11709 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11710 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11711
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011712 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011713 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11714 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11715 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11716 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11717 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11718 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11719 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11720 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11721 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11722 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011723
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011724 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011725 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11726 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11727 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011728
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011729 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11730 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11731
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011732 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011733 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11734 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011735
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011736 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11737 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011738 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011739 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11740 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011741 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011742 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011743 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011744 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11745 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011746 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011747 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11748 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011749
11750 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11751 followed by some converters.
11752
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011753 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11754 <var-name>.
11755
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011756 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11757 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11758 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11759 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11760 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11761
11762 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11763 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11764 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11765 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11766 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11767 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11768 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11769 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11770 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11771 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11772 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11773
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011774 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11775 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11776 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11777 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11778 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11779
11780 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11781
11782 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11783
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011784 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11785 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11786 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11787 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11788 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11789 evaluated.
11790
11791 Example:
11792 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11793
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011794 Example:
11795
11796 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011797 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011798
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011799 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011800 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11801 # and reject everything else.
11802 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11803 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011804 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011805 tcp-request content reject
11806
11807 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011808 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11809 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11810 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011811 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011812
11813 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11814 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11815 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011816 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011817 tcp-request content reject
11818
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011819 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011820 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011821 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011822 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011823 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11824 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011825
11826 Example:
11827 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11828 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011829 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011830
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011831 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011832 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011833
11834 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011835 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011836 # protecting all our sites
11837 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011838 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11839 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011840 ...
11841 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11842
11843 backend http_dynamic
11844 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011845 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011846 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011847 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011848 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011849 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011850 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011851
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011852 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011853
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011854 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11855 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011856
11857
11858tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11859 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011861 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011862 Arguments :
11863 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11864 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11865 as explained at the top of this document.
11866
11867 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11868 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11869 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11870 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11871 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11872
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011873 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11874 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11875 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11876 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11877
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011878 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11879 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011880 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011881 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011882 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11883 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11884 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11885 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011886
11887 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11888 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11889 it pass through unaffected.
11890
11891 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11892 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11893 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011894 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011895 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11896 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011897 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11898 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11899 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011900
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011901 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011902 "timeout client".
11903
11904
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011905tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11906 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11908 no | no | yes | yes
11909 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011910 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11911 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011912
11913 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11914
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011915 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011916 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11917 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011918 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11919 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011920
11921 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11922
11923 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11924 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11925 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11926 inserted.
11927
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011928 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011929 - accept :
11930 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11931 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11932 the rules evaluation.
11933
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011934 - close :
11935 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11936 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11937 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11938 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11939 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11940 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011941 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011942 protocols.
11943
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011944 - reject :
11945 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11946 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011947 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011948
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011949 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11950 Sets a variable.
11951
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011952 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11953 Unsets a variable.
11954
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011955 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11956 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11957 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11958 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11959
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011960 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11961 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11962 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11963 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11964
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011965 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11966 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11967 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11968 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11969 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011970
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011971 - "silent-drop" :
11972 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011973 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011974 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11975 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11976 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11977 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11978 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011979 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11980 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011981 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11982 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011983 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011984 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11985 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11986 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11987 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11988
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011989 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11990 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11991
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011992 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11993 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11994 for changing the default action to a reject.
11995
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011996 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11997 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11998 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11999 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012000 period.
12001
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012002 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12003 declared inline.
12004
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012005 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12006 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012007 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012008 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12009 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012010 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012011 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012012 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012013 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12014 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012015 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012016 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12017 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012018
12019 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12020 followed by some converters.
12021
12022 Example:
12023
12024 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12025
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012026 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12027 <var-name>.
12028
12029 Example:
12030
12031 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12032
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012033 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12034 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12035 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12036 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12037 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12038
12039 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12040
12041 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12042
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012043 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12044
12045 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12046
12047
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012048tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12049 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12051 no | yes | yes | no
12052 Arguments :
12053 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12054 below.
12055
12056 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12057
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012058 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012059 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12060 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12061 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12062 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12063 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12064 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12065 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012066 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012067 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12068 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12069 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12070 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12071 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12072 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12073 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12074 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12075 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12076 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12077 instead.
12078
12079 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12080 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12081 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12082 rules which may be inserted.
12083
12084 Several types of actions are supported :
12085 - accept : the request is accepted
12086 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12087 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12088 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012089 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012090 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012091 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012092 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012093 - silent-drop
12094
12095 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12096 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12097 sections for a complete description.
12098
12099 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12100 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12101 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12102
12103 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12104 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12105 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12106 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12107 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12108
12109 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12110 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12111
12112 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12113 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12114 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12115
12116 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12117 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12118 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12119
12120 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12121 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12122 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12123
12124 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12125 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12126 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12127
12128 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12129
12130 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12131
12132
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012133tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12134 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12136 no | no | yes | yes
12137 Arguments :
12138 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12139 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12140 as explained at the top of this document.
12141
12142 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12143
12144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012145timeout check <timeout>
12146 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12147 established.
12148
12149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12150 yes | no | yes | yes
12151 Arguments:
12152 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12153 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12154 as explained at the top of this document.
12155
12156 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12157 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012158 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012159 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012160 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12161 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12162 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012163
12164 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12165 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12166
12167 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12168 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012169 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012170
12171 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12172 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12173 forget about it.
12174
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012175 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12176 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012177
12178
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012179timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012180 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12182 yes | yes | yes | no
12183 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012184 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012185 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12186 as explained at the top of this document.
12187
12188 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12189 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12190 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012191 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12192 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12193 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12194 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012195 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12196 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12197 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012198 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012199 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012200 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12201 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012202 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12203 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012204
12205 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12206 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12207 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12208 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012209 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012210 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012212 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012213
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012214 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012215
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012216
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012217timeout client-fin <timeout>
12218 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12220 yes | yes | yes | no
12221 Arguments :
12222 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12223 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12224 as explained at the top of this document.
12225
12226 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12227 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12228 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12229 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12230 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12231 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12232 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012233 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12234 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12235 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012236
12237 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12238 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12239 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12240
12241 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12242
12243
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012244timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012245 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12247 yes | no | yes | yes
12248 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012249 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012250 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12251 as explained at the top of this document.
12252
12253 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012254 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012255 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012256 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012257 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12258 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012259
12260 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12261 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12262 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12263 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012264 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012265 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12266
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012267 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012269
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012270timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12271 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12272 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12273 yes | yes | yes | yes
12274 Arguments :
12275 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12276 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12277 as explained at the top of this document.
12278
12279 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12280 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12281 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12282 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12283 once the request has started to present itself.
12284
12285 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12286 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12287 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12288 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12289 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12290
12291 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12292 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12293 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12294 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12295
12296 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12297 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012298 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012299 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12300 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012301 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012302
12303 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12304 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12305 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12306 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12307
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012308 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12309 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012310 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12311
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012312 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12313
12314
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012315timeout http-request <timeout>
12316 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012318 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012319 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012320 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012321 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12322 as explained at the top of this document.
12323
12324 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12325 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12326 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12327 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12328 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12329 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12330 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012331 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12332 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12333 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12334 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012335 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012336 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12337 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012338
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012339 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12340 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12341 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12342 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12343 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012344 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012345
12346 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12347 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012348 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012349 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12350 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12351
12352 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012353 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12354 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12355 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012356
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012357 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012358 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012359
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012360
12361timeout queue <timeout>
12362 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12364 yes | no | yes | yes
12365 Arguments :
12366 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12367 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12368 as explained at the top of this document.
12369
12370 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12371 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12372 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12373 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12374 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12375
12376 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12377 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12378 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12379 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12380
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012381 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012382
12383
12384timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012385 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12387 yes | no | yes | yes
12388 Arguments :
12389 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12390 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12391 as explained at the top of this document.
12392
12393 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12394 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12395 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12396 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12397 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12398 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12399 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12400
12401 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12402 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12403 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12404 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12405 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012406 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012407 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012408 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12409 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012410 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12411 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012412
12413 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12414 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12415 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12416 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012417 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012418 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12419
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012420 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012421
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012422
12423timeout server-fin <timeout>
12424 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12426 yes | no | yes | yes
12427 Arguments :
12428 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12429 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12430 as explained at the top of this document.
12431
12432 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12433 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12434 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12435 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12436 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12437 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12438 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12439 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12440 situations, it should not be needed.
12441
12442 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12443 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12444 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12445
12446 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12447
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012448
12449timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012450 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12452 yes | yes | yes | yes
12453 Arguments :
12454 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12455 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12456 as explained at the top of this document.
12457
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012458 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12459 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12460 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012461
12462 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12463 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12464 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12465 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012466 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012467
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012468 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012469
12470
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012471timeout tunnel <timeout>
12472 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12474 yes | no | yes | yes
12475 Arguments :
12476 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12477 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12478 as explained at the top of this document.
12479
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012480 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012481 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12482 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12483 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012484 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12485 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012486 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12487 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12488 specified.
12489
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012490 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12491 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12492 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12493 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12494 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12495 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12496 state.
12497
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012498 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12499 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12500 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12501 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012502 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012503
12504 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12505 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12506 forget about it.
12507
12508 Example :
12509 defaults http
12510 option http-server-close
12511 timeout connect 5s
12512 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012513 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012514 timeout server 30s
12515 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12516
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012517 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012518
12519
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012520transparent (deprecated)
12521 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012523 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012524 Arguments : none
12525
12526 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12527 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12528 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12529 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12530 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12531 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12532 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12533 appropriate server.
12534
12535 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12536
12537 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12538 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12539
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012540 See also: "option transparent"
12541
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012542unique-id-format <string>
12543 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12544 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12545 yes | yes | yes | no
12546 Arguments :
12547 <string> is a log-format string.
12548
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012549 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12550 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12551 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12552 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012553
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012554 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12555 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12556 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12557 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12558 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12559 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12560 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12561 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012562
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012563 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12564 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012565
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012566 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012567
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012568 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012569
12570 will generate:
12571
12572 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12573
12574 See also: "unique-id-header"
12575
12576unique-id-header <name>
12577 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12578 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12579 yes | yes | yes | no
12580 Arguments :
12581 <name> is the name of the header.
12582
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012583 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12584 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012585
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012586 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012587
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012588 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012589 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12590
12591 will generate:
12592
12593 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12594
12595 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012596
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012597use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012598 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012599 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12600 no | yes | yes | no
12601 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012602 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12603 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012604
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012605 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12606 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012607
12608 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12609 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12610 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012611 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012612 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012613 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12614 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012615
12616 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12617 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12618 assign the backend.
12619
12620 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12621 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12622 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12623 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12624 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12625 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12626
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012627 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012628 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012629 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12630 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12631 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12632
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012633 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12634 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12635 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12636 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12637 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12638 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12639 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12640 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12641 cannot be forced from the request.
12642
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012643 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012644 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12645 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12646
12647 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12648 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012649
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012650use-fcgi-app <name>
12651 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12653 no | no | yes | yes
12654 Arguments :
12655 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12656
12657 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012658
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012659use-server <server> if <condition>
12660use-server <server> unless <condition>
12661 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12663 no | no | yes | yes
12664 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012665 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12666 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012667
12668 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12669
12670 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12671 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12672 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12673
12674 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12675 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12676 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12677 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12678 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12679 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12680 matches will assign the server.
12681
12682 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12683 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12684 with the next rules until one matches.
12685
12686 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12687 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12688 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12689 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12690
12691 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12692 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12693 stripped.
12694
12695 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12696 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012697 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12698 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12699 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012700
12701 Example :
12702 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12703 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12704 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12705 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012706 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012707 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012708 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012709 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12710 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12711
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012712 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12713 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12714 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12715 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012716 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012717 and we fall back to load balancing.
12718
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012719 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012720
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012721
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100127225. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012723--------------------------
12724
12725The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12726depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12727settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12728written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12729described in this section.
12730
12731
127325.1. Bind options
12733-----------------
12734
12735The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12736as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12737no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12738parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12739while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12740provided immediately after the setting name.
12741
12742The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12743
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012744accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12745 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12746 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12747 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12748 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12749 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12750 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12751 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12752 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12753 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012754 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12755 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12756 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012757
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012758accept-proxy
12759 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012760 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12761 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012762 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12763 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12764 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12765 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012766 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012767 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12768 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012769 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12770 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012771
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012772allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012773 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012774 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012775 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012776 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12777 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012778
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012779alpn <protocols>
12780 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12781 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12782 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012783 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012784 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012785 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12786 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12787 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12788 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12789 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12790 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12791 preference, like below :
12792
12793 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012794
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012795backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012796 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012797 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12798
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012799curves <curves>
12800 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12801 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12802 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12803 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12804 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12805 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12806
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012807ecdhe <named curve>
12808 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012809 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12810 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012811
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012812ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012813 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12814 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12815 client's certificate.
12816
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012817ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12818 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12819 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12820 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12821 error is ignored.
12822
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012823ca-sign-file <cafile>
12824 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12825 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12826 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12827 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12828 'generate-certificates' for details.
12829
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012830ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012831 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12832 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12833 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12834 'generate-certificates' for details.
12835
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012836ca-verify-file <cafile>
12837 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12838 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12839 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12840 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12841 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12842
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012843ciphers <ciphers>
12844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12845 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012846 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012847 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012848 information and recommendations see e.g.
12849 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12850 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12851 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12852
12853ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12855 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12856 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12857 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012858 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12859 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012860
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012861crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012862 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12863 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12864 to verify client's certificate.
12865
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012866crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12868 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12869 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12870 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12871 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012872 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12873 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012874
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012875 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12876 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12877
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012878 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12879 are loaded.
12880
12881 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012882 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12883 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12884 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12885 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12886 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12887 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12888 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012889 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012890
12891 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12892 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12893 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12894 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012895 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12896 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012897
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012898 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012899
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012900 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012901 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012902 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12903 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012904 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12905 clients).
12906
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012907 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12908 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12909 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12910 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12911 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12912 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12913 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12914 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12915 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12916 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12917 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12918 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12919 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12920
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012921 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12922 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12923 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12924 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12925 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12926
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012927 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12928 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12929 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12930 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012931
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012932 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
12933 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
12934 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012935
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012936crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012937 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012938 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012939 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012940 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012941
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012942crt-list <file>
12943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012944 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12945 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012946
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012947 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12948
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012949 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12950 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12951 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12952 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12953 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012954
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012955 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012956 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
12957 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
12958 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
12959 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
12960 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012961 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12962 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12963 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012964
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020012965 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
12966 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
12967 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012968
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012969 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12970
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030012971 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
12972 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
12973 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
12974 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
12975 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
12976 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
12977 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
12978 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012979
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012980 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030012981 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012982 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012983 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012984 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012985 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012986
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012987defer-accept
12988 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12989 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12990 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012991 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012992 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12993 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12994 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12995 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12996 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12997 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12998 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12999
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013000expose-fd listeners
13001 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13002 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013003 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13004 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013005 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013006
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013007force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013008 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013009 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013010 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013011 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013012
13013force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013014 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013015 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013016 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013017
13018force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013019 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013020 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013021 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013022
13023force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013024 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013025 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013026 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013027
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013028force-tlsv13
13029 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13030 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013031 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013032
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013033generate-certificates
13034 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13035 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13036 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13037 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13038 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13039 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13040 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13041 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13042 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13043 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13044 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13045
13046 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13047 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013048 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013049 certificate is used many times.
13050
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013051gid <gid>
13052 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13053 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13054 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13055 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13056 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13057
13058group <group>
13059 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13060 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13061 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13062 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13063 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13064
13065id <id>
13066 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13067 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13068 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13069 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13070
13071interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013072 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13073 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13074 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13075 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13076 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13077 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013078 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13079 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13080 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13081 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13082 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13083 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013084
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013085level <level>
13086 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13087 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13088 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013089 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013090 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13091 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13092 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013093 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013094 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013095 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013096 all counters).
13097
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013098severity-output <format>
13099 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13100 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13101 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13102 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13103 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13104 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13105 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13106 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13107 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13108 rfc5424 convention.
13109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013110maxconn <maxconn>
13111 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13112 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13113 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13114 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13115 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13116 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13117 eat all memory.
13118
13119mode <mode>
13120 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13121 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13122 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13123 UNIX sockets.
13124
13125mss <maxseg>
13126 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13127 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13128 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13129 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13130 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13131 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13132 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13133 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13134 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13135 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13136 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13137
13138name <name>
13139 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13140 page.
13141
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013142namespace <name>
13143 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13144 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13145 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13146 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13147
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013148nice <nice>
13149 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13150 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13151 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13152 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13153 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13154 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13155 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13156 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13157 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13158 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13159 one for an RDP socket.
13160
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013161no-ca-names
13162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13163 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013164 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013165
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013166no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013167 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013168 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013169 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013170 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013171 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13172 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013173
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013174no-tls-tickets
13175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13176 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13177 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013178 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13179 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013180 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13181 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13182 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013183
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013184no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013185 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013186 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013187 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013188 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013189 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13190 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013191
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013192no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013194 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013195 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013196 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013197 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13198 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013199
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013200no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013201 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013202 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013203 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013204 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013205 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13206 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013207
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013208no-tlsv13
13209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13210 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13211 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13212 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013213 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13214 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013215
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013216npn <protocols>
13217 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13218 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13219 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013220 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013221 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013222 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13223 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13224 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13225 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13226 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013227
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013228prefer-client-ciphers
13229 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13230 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13231 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013232 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13233 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13234 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013235
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013236process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013237 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013238 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013239 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013240 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13241 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13242 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13243 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013244 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013245 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13246 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13247 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13248 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13249 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013250
13251 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13252
13253 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13254 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13255 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13256 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13257 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13258 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13259 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13260 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013261
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013262proto <name>
13263 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13264 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13265 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
13266 in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013267 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013268 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013269 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013270 h2" on the bind line.
13271
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013272ssl
13273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013274 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013275 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13276 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013277 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13278 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013279
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013280ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13281 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013282 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13283 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13284 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013285 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13286
13287ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013288 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13289 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13290 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13291 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013292
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013293strict-sni
13294 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13295 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13296 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13297 See the "crt" option for more information.
13298
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013299tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013300 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013301 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13302 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013303 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013304 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13305 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13306 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13307 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13308 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13309 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13310 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13311
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013312tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013313 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013314 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13315 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13316 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13317 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13318 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13319 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13320 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013321 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13322 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13323 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013324
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013325tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13326 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013327 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13328 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13329 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13330 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13331 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13332 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13333 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13334 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13335 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13336 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013337 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13338 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13339
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013340transparent
13341 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13342 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13343 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13344 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13345 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13346 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13347 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13348 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13349 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13350 so check for support with your vendor.
13351
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013352v4v6
13353 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13354 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13355 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13356 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013357 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013358
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013359v6only
13360 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13361 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13362 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013363 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13364 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013365
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013366uid <uid>
13367 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13368 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13369 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13370 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13371 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13372
13373user <user>
13374 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13375 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13376 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13377 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13378 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13379
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013380verify [none|optional|required]
13381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13382 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13383 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13384 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13385 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013386 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13387 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13388 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13389 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200133915.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013392------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013393
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013394The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13395which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13396arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13397settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13398after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13399Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13400address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013402 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013403 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013404
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013405Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13406keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13407
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013408The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013409
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013410addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013411 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013412 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13413 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13414 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13415 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13416 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013417
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013418agent-check
13419 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013420 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013421 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13422 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13423 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013424
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013425 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013426 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013427 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13428 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13429 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013430
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013431 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13432 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13433 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13434 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13435 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013436
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013437 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013438 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013439
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013440 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13441 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13442 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013443
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013444 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13445 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13446 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013447
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013448 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013449 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13450 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13451 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13452 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013453 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013454 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013455
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013456 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13457 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013458
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013459 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13460 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13461 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13462 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13463 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13464 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13465 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13466 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13467 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013468
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013469 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13470 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013471 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13472 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13473 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013474 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013475
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013476 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013477 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013478
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013479agent-send <string>
13480 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13481 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13482 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13483 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13484 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13485
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013486agent-inter <delay>
13487 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13488 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13489
13490 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13491 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13492 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13493 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13494 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13495 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13496 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13497 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13498 of backends use the same servers.
13499
13500 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13501
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013502agent-addr <addr>
13503 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13504
13505 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13506 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13507 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13508 hostname, it will be resolved.
13509
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013510agent-port <port>
13511 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13512
13513 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13514
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013515allow-0rtt
13516 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013517 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13518 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013519
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013520alpn <protocols>
13521 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13522 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13523 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013524 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013525 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13526 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13527 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13528 now obsolete NPN extension.
13529 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13530 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13531
13532 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013534backup
13535 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13536 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13537 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13538 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013539 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13540 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013541
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013542ca-file <cafile>
13543 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13544 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13545 server's certificate.
13546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013547check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013548 This option enables health checks on a server:
13549 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13550 considered available.
13551 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13552 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13553 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13554 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13555 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13556 set.
13557 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13558 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13559 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13560 exchanges succeed.
13561
13562 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13563 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13564 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13565 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13566 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013567 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013568 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13569
13570 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13571 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13572
13573 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13574 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13575
13576 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13577 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13578 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13579 available.
13580
13581 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13582 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13583 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13584
13585 Example:
13586 # simple tcp check
13587 backend foo
13588 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13589 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13590 backend foo
13591 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13592 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13593 backend foo
13594 option tcp-check
13595 tcp-check connect
13596 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013597
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013598check-send-proxy
13599 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13600 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13601 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13602 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13603 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13604 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13605 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13606
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013607check-alpn <protocols>
13608 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13609 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13610 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13611
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013612check-proto <name>
13613 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13614 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13615 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
13616 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013617 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013618 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13619 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13620
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013621check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013622 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013623 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13624 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013625
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013626check-ssl
13627 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13628 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13629 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13630 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013631 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013632 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13633 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013634 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013635 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13636 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013637
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013638check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013639 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013640 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13641 for normal traffic.
13642
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013643ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013644 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13645 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13646 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013647 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13648 information and recommendations see e.g.
13649 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13650 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13651 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013652
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013653ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13654 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13655 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13656 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13657 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013658 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13659 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13660 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013662cookie <value>
13663 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13664 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13665 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13666 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13667 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13668 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13669 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13670
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013671crl-file <crlfile>
13672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13673 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13674 to verify server's certificate.
13675
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013676crt <cert>
13677 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13678 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13679 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13680 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13681 certificate request.
13682
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013683disabled
13684 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13685 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13686 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13687 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13688 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013689 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013690
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013691enabled
13692 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13693 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13694 default value.
13695 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13696 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013697
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013698error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013699 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13700 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13701 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013702
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013703 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013704
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013705fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013706 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13707 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13708 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13709
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013710force-sslv3
13711 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13712 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013713 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013714 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013715
13716force-tlsv10
13717 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013718 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013719 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013720
13721force-tlsv11
13722 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013723 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013724 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013725
13726force-tlsv12
13727 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013728 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013729 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013730
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013731force-tlsv13
13732 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13733 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013734 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013736id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013737 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13738 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13739 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013740
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013741init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13742 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13743 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013744 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013745 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13746 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13747 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13748 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13749 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13750 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13751 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13752 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13753 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013754 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013755 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13756 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13757 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13758 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13759 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13760 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013761 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013762
13763 Example:
13764 defaults
13765 # never fail on address resolution
13766 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13767
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013768inter <delay>
13769fastinter <delay>
13770downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013771 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13772 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13773 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13774 between checks depending on the server state :
13775
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013776 Server state | Interval used
13777 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13778 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13779 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13780 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13781 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13782 or yet unchecked. |
13783 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13784 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13785 | "inter" otherwise.
13786 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013788 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13789 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13790 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13791 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013792 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13793 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13794 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13795 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13796 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013797
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013798log-proto <logproto>
13799 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13800 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13801 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13802 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013804maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013805 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13806 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013807 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13808 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013809 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13810 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13811 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13812 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13813
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013814 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13815 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13816 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13817 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13818 than 50 concurrent requests.
13819
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013820maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013821 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13822 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13823 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13824 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020013825 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
13826 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
13827 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
13828 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
13829 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
13830 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
13831 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013832
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013833max-reuse <count>
13834 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13835 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13836 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13837 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13838 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13839 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13840 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13841 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013843minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013844 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13845 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13846 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13847 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13848 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13849 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013850 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013851 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013852
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013853namespace <name>
13854 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13855 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13856 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13857 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13858
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013859no-agent-check
13860 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13861 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13862 default value.
13863 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13864 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13865
13866no-backup
13867 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13868 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13869 default value.
13870 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13871 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13872
13873no-check
13874 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13875 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13876 default value.
13877 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13878 "default-server" "check" setting.
13879
13880no-check-ssl
13881 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13882 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13883 default value.
13884 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13885 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13886
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013887no-send-proxy
13888 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13889 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13890 default value.
13891 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13892 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13893
13894no-send-proxy-v2
13895 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13896 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13897 default value.
13898 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13899 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13900
13901no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13902 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13903 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13904 default value.
13905 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13906 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13907
13908no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13909 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13910 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13911 default value.
13912 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13913 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13914
13915no-ssl
13916 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13917 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13918 default value.
13919 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13920 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13921
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010013922 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
13923 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
13924 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
13925
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013926no-ssl-reuse
13927 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13928 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13929 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13930 and for paranoid users.
13931
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013932no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013933 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13934 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013935 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013936
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013937 Supported in default-server: No
13938
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013939no-tls-tickets
13940 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13941 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13942 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013943 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13944 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013945 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13946 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13947 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013948 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013949
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013950no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013951 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013952 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13953 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013954 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13955 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013956 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013957
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013958 Supported in default-server: No
13959
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013960no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013961 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013962 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13963 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013964 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13965 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013966 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013967
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013968 Supported in default-server: No
13969
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013970no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013971 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013972 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13973 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013974 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13975 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013976 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013977
13978 Supported in default-server: No
13979
13980no-tlsv13
13981 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13982 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13983 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13984 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13985 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013986 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013987
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013988 Supported in default-server: No
13989
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013990no-verifyhost
13991 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13992 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13993 default value.
13994 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13995 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013996
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013997no-tfo
13998 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13999 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14000 default value.
14001 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14002 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14003
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014004non-stick
14005 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14006 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14007 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14008
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014009npn <protocols>
14010 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14011 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14012 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014013 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014014 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14015 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14016 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014018observe <mode>
14019 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14020 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14021 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14022 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14023 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14024 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014025 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014026
14027 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14028
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014029on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014030 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14031 Currently, four modes are available:
14032 - fastinter: force fastinter
14033 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14034 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14035 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14036 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14037
14038 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14039
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014040on-marked-down <action>
14041 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14042 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014043 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14044 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14045 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14046 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14047 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14048 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14049 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14050 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014051
14052 Actions are disabled by default
14053
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014054on-marked-up <action>
14055 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14056 Currently one action is available:
14057 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14058 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14059 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14060 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014061 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14062 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014063 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14064 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14065
14066 Actions are disabled by default
14067
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014068pool-low-conn <max>
14069 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14070 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14071 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14072 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14073 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14074 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14075 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14076 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14077 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14078 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
14079 applying to "http-reuse".
14080
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014081pool-max-conn <max>
14082 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14083 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14084 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14085 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14086 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14087 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14088
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014089pool-purge-delay <delay>
14090 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014091 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014092 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014094port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014095 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014096 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14097 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14098 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14099 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14100 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014101
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014102proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014103 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14104 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14105 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
14106 reported in haproxy -vv.
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014107 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014108 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014110redir <prefix>
14111 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14112 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14113 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14114 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14115 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14116 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14117 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14118 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014119 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014120 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014121 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14122 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14123 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14124 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14125
14126 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14127
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014128rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014129 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14130 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14131 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14132
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014133resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14134 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14135 server.
14136
14137 Available options:
14138
14139 * allow-dup-ip
14140 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14141 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14142 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14143 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14144 For such case, simply enable this option.
14145 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14146
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014147 * ignore-weight
14148 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14149 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14150 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14151
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014152 * prevent-dup-ip
14153 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14154 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14155 same fqdn.
14156 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14157
14158 Example:
14159 backend b_myapp
14160 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14161 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14162 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14163
14164 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14165 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14166 it
14167 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14168 different address
14169
14170 Default value: not set
14171
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014172resolve-prefer <family>
14173 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14174 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14175 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14176 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14177
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014178 Default value: ipv6
14179
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014180 Example:
14181
14182 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014183
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014184resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014185 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014186 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014187 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014188 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14189 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014190 configured network, another address is selected.
14191
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014192 Example:
14193
14194 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014195
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014196resolvers <id>
14197 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14198 hostname.
14199
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014200 Example:
14201
14202 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014203
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014204 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014205
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014206send-proxy
14207 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14208 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14209 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14210 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014211 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14212 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14213 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14214 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14215 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14216 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14217 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14218 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14219 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14220 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014221 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14222 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014223
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014224send-proxy-v2
14225 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14226 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14227 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14228 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014229 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14230 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14231 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14232 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014233
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014234proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014235 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14236 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14237
14238 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14239 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14240 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14241 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14242 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14243 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14244 connection is supported).
14245 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14246 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14247 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14248 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14249 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14250 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14251 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014252
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014253send-proxy-v2-ssl
14254 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14255 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14256 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14257 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14258 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14259 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14260 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014261 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14262 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014263
14264send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14265 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14266 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14267 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14268 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14269 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14270 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14271 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14272 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014273 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14274 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014276slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014277 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14278 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14279 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14280 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14281 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14282 parameters :
14283
14284 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14285 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14286
14287 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14288 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14289 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14290 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14291
14292 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14293 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14294 seen as failed.
14295
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014296sni <expression>
14297 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14298 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14299 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14300 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014301 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14302 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014303 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014304 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14305 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014306
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014307source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014308source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014309source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014310 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14311 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14312 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14313 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14314
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014315 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14316 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14317 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14318 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14319 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14320 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14321 server.
14322
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014323 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14324 specifying the source address without port(s).
14325
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014326ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014327 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14328 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14329 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14330 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14331 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14332 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014333 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14334 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014335
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014336ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14337 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14338 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14339 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14340
14341ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14342 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14343 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14344 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14345
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014346ssl-reuse
14347 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14348 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14349 default value.
14350 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14351 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14352
14353stick
14354 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14355 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14356 default value.
14357 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14358 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014359
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014360socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014361 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014362 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14363 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14364
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014365tcp-ut <delay>
14366 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14367 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14368 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014369 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014370 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14371 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14372 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14373 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14374 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14375 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14376 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14377 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14378 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14379
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014380tfo
14381 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14382 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14383 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14384 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14385 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014386 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014387
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014388track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014389 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14390 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14391 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14392 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014393 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14394
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014395tls-tickets
14396 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14397 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14398 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014399 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14400 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14401 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014402 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014403 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014404
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014405verify [none|required]
14406 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014407 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014408 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14409 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014410 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014411 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14412 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14413 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14414 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14415 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14416 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14417 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14418 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014419
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014420verifyhost <hostname>
14421 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014422 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14423 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14424 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14425 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14426 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14427 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14428 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14429 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014430
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014431weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014432 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14433 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14434 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014435 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14436 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14437 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14438 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14439 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14440 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014441
14442
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144435.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14444-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014445
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014446HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14447using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014448configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014449This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14450can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14451workload.
14452This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14453resolution at run time.
14454Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14455carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14456
14457
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144585.3.1. Global overview
14459----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014460
14461As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14462different steps of the process life:
14463
14464 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14465 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14466 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14467
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014468 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14469 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014470
14471A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14472 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14473 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14474 resolution to know this new IP.
14475
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014476When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014477HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014478SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14479from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14480will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14481will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014482
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014483A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014484 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014485 first valid response.
14486
14487 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14488 servers return an error.
14489
14490
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200144915.3.2. The resolvers section
14492----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014493
14494This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014495HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14496contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014497
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014498When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14499uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14500is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14501answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14502
14503When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014504used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014505
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014506 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14507 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14508 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014509
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014510 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14511 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014512
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014513 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14514 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14515 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014516
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014517For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14518following scenarios are possible:
14519
14520 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14521 ignored
14522
14523 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14524 applied
14525
14526 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14527 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14528
14529 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14530 retries the query with a new type
14531
14532 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14533 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014534
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014535As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14536a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014537<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014538
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014539
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014540resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014541 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014542
14543A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14544
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014545accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014546 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014547 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014548 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14549 by RFC 6891)
14550
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014551 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
14552
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014553nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
14554 DNS server description:
14555 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
14556 <ip> : IP address of the server
14557 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
14558
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014559parse-resolv-conf
14560 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14561 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14562 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14563
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014564hold <status> <period>
14565 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14566 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014567 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014568 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014569 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14570 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14571 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14572
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014573 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014574
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014575resolve_retries <nb>
14576 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14577 giving up.
14578 Default value: 3
14579
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014580 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14581 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14582 type.
14583
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014584timeout <event> <time>
14585 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14586 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14587 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014588 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14589 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014590 Default value: 1s
14591 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014592 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014593 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014594 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14595 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14596
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014597 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014598
14599 resolvers mydns
14600 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14601 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014602 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014603 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014604 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014605 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014606 hold other 30s
14607 hold refused 30s
14608 hold nx 30s
14609 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014610 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014611 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014612
14613
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200146146. Cache
14615---------
14616
14617HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14618(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14619RAM.
14620
14621The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14622this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14623
14624If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14625independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14626when we try to allocate a new one.
14627
14628The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14629
14630It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14631"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14632for more details.
14633
14634When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14635replaced by "<CACHE>".
14636
14637
146386.1. Limitation
14639----------------
14640
14641The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14642
14643- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014644- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14645 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14646 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014647- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14648- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014649- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14650 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14651 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014652- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
14653 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010014654- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
14655 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
14656 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014657
14658- If the request is not a GET
14659- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14660- If the request contains an Authorization header
14661
14662
146636.2. Setup
14664-----------
14665
14666To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14667the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14668
14669
146706.2.1. Cache section
14671---------------------
14672
14673cache <name>
14674 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14675 size of cache is mandatory.
14676
14677total-max-size <megabytes>
14678 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14679 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14680
14681max-object-size <bytes>
14682 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14683 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14684 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14685
14686max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014687 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014688 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14689 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14690 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14691 default.
14692
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014693process-vary <on/off>
14694 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014695 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
14696 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
14697 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010014698 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010014699
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014700max-secondary-entries <number>
14701 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
14702 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
14703 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
14704
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014705
147066.2.2. Proxy section
14707---------------------
14708
14709http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14710 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14711 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14712 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14713 after this one.
14714
14715http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14716 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14717 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14718 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14719 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14720
14721
14722Example:
14723
14724 backend bck1
14725 mode http
14726
14727 http-request cache-use foobar
14728 http-response cache-store foobar
14729 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14730
14731 cache foobar
14732 total-max-size 4
14733 max-age 240
14734
14735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147367. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14737----------------------------------
14738
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014739HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014740client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14741The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14742these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14743but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14744data called patterns.
14745
14746
147477.1. ACL basics
14748---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014749
14750The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14751content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14752from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14753simple :
14754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014756 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014757 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14758 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014760The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14761adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014762
14763In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14764
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014765 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014766
14767This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14768Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14769and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014770an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14771conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14772as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14773are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014774
14775ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14776'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14777which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14778
14779There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14780performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014782The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14783specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14784this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014785methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14786ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014787
14788Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14789 - boolean
14790 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14791 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14792 - string
14793 - data block
14794
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014795Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14796converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14797would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14798The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14799which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14800
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014801Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14802keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14803fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14804which are summarized in the table below :
14805
14806 +---------------------+-----------------+
14807 | Sample or converter | Default |
14808 | output type | matching method |
14809 +---------------------+-----------------+
14810 | boolean | bool |
14811 +---------------------+-----------------+
14812 | integer | int |
14813 +---------------------+-----------------+
14814 | ip | ip |
14815 +---------------------+-----------------+
14816 | string | str |
14817 +---------------------+-----------------+
14818 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14819 +---------------------+-----------------+
14820
14821Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14822matching method, see below.
14823
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014824The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14825 - boolean
14826 - integer or integer range
14827 - IP address / network
14828 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14829 - regular expression
14830 - hex block
14831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014832The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14833
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014834 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14835 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014836 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014837 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014838 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014839 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014840 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14843read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14844if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14845lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14846will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14847beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14848a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14849lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14850exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14851
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014852The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14853parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14854ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14855a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14856check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14857
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014858The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14859socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14860file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014862Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14863loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14864
14865 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14866
14867In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14868the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14869case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14870as well.
14871
14872The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14873sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14874do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14875methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14876is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014877obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14879default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14880that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14881string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14882
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014883The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14884By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14885string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14886resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14887server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014888waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014889flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14890function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14893sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14894be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014895
14896 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14897 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14899 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14900 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14901 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014902
14903 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14904 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014905 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014906
14907 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014909
14910 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014911 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014912
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014913 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014914 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14915
14916 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14917 binary or string samples.
14918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14920 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014922 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14923 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14924 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14927 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14930 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014932 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14933 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014935 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14936 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014937 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14940 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14941 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014942
14943For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14944request, it is possible to do :
14945
14946 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14947
14948In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14949buffer, one would use the following acl :
14950
14951 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14952
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014953On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14954possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14955
14956 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014958All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14959criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14960method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14961to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14962criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14963the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014965If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014966the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14967For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014969 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14970 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14971 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14972 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014973
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014974
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014975The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14976types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14977combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14978brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14979default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981 +-------------------------------------------------+
14982 | Input sample type |
14983 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014984 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14986 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14987 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014988 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014989 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014990 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014991 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014992 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014993 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014994 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014996 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014997 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014998 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014999 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015000 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015002 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015003 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015004 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015005 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015006 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015007 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015008 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015009 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15010 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15011 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015012
15013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150147.1.1. Matching booleans
15015------------------------
15016
15017In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15018Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15019When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15020that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15021
15022Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15023return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15024"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15025
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150277.1.2. Matching integers
15028------------------------
15029
15030Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15031enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15032to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15033
15034Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15035matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15036lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015037
15038For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15039unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15040representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15041
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015042As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15043two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15044instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15045ranges and operators.
15046
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015047For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015048operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15049Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15050of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015052Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015053
15054 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15055 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15056 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15057 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15058 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15059
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015060For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015061
15062 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15063
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015064This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15065
15066 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15067
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150697.1.3. Matching strings
15070-----------------------
15071
15072String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15073different forms :
15074
15075 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015076 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015077
15078 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015079 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015080
15081 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15082 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15083
15084 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15085 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15086
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015087 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015088 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15089 matches.
15090
15091 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15092 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15093 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015094
15095String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15096exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15097characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15098string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15099to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015100before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015101
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015102Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15103(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15104Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15105
15106Example:
15107 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15108 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151117.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15112---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015113
15114Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15115they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15116possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15117passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15118the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015119the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15120match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015121
15122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200151237.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15124-------------------------------------
15125
15126It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15127not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15128a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15129to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15130digits may be used upper or lower case.
15131
15132Example :
15133 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15134 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15135
15136
151377.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15138---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015139
15140IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15141netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15142within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015143host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015144difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15145at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15146does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15147parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015148
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015149The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15150abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15151
15152 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15153 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15154 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15155 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15156 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15157 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15158 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15159 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15160
15161Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15162192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15163
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015164IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15165Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15166trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15167IPv6 patterns.
15168
15169HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15170following situations :
15171 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15172 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15173 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15174 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15175 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15176 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15177 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15178 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15179 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15180 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015182
151837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15184----------------------------------
15185
15186Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15187combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15188
15189 - AND (implicit)
15190 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15191 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015193A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015195 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015197Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15198indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015200For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15201"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15202requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15203is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15204
15205 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015206 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15207 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15208 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209
15210To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15211and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15212
15213 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15214 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15215 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15216 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15217
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015218 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015219 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15220 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15221 use_backend www if host_www
15222
15223It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15224expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15225be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15226the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15227
15228 The following rule :
15229
15230 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015231 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015232
15233 Can also be written that way :
15234
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015235 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236
15237It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15238to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15239simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15240sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15241good use is the following :
15242
15243 With named ACLs :
15244
15245 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15246 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15247 monitor fail if site_dead
15248
15249 With anonymous ACLs :
15250
15251 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15252
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015253See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15254keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255
15256
152577.3. Fetching samples
15258---------------------
15259
15260Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15261against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15262sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15263ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15264of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15265available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15266
15267This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15268Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15269compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15270deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15271
15272The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15273matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15274method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15275indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15276
15277As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15278when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15279mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15280the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15281ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15282
15283Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15284multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15285when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015286incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15287are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015288is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15289all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15290
15291Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15292 - name
15293 - name(arg1)
15294 - name(arg1,arg2)
15295
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015296
152977.3.1. Converters
15298-----------------
15299
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015300Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15301of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15302is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15303was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015304has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015305unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15306
15307These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15308sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15309the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015310support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015311
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015312A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15313support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15314supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15315(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15316bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015319
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001532051d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15321 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15322 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15323 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15324 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15325 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15326
15327 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015328 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15329 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015330 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15331 frontend http-in
15332 bind *:8081
15333 default_backend servers
15334 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15335 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15336
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015337add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015338 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015339 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015340 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15341 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015342 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015343 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15344 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15345 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15346 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015347 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015348 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015349
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015350aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15351 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15352 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15353 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15354 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15355 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15356 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15357
15358 Example:
15359 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15360 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15361
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015362and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015363 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015364 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015365 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15366 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015367 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015368 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15369 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15370 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15371 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015372 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015373 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015374
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015375b64dec
15376 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15377 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
15378
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015379base64
15380 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015381 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015382 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
15383
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015384bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015385 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015386 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015387 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015388 presence of a flag).
15389
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015390bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15391 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15392 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015393 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015394
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015395concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15396 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15397 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15398 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15399 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15400 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15401 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15402 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15403 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15404 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15405 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015406 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015407 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015408 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15409 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015410
15411 Example:
15412 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15413 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15414 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015415 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015416 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15417
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015418cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015419 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15420 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015421
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015422crc32([<avalanche>])
15423 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15424 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15425 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15426 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15427 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15428 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15429 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15430 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15431 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15432 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015433 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15434
15435crc32c([<avalanche>])
15436 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15437 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15438 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15439 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15440 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15441 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15442 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15443 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015444
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015445cut_crlf
15446 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15447 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15448 updated.
15449
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015450da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015451 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15452 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15453 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15454 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015455 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015456 configuration language.
15457
15458 Example:
15459 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015460 bind *:8881
15461 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015462 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015463
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015464debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15465 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15466 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15467 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15468 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15469 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15470 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15471 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15472 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15473 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15474 printable sample types.
15475
15476 Example:
15477 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015478
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015479digest(<algorithm>)
15480 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15481 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15482
15483 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15484 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15485
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015486div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015487 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15488 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015489 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015490 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15491 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015492 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015493 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15494 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15495 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15496 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015497 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015498 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015499
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015500djb2([<avalanche>])
15501 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15502 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15503 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15504 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15505 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15506 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15507 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015508 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15509 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015510
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015511even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015512 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015513 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15514
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015515field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15516 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15517 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15518 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15519 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15520 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15521 fields.
15522
15523 Example :
15524 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15525 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15526 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15527 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15528 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015529
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015530fix_is_valid
15531 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15532 Information eXchange):
15533
15534 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15535 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015536 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015537 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
15538 - checks the MstType tag is the third tag.
15539 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15540 checksum
15541
15542 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15543 the server can be parsed.
15544
15545 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15546 message, false if not.
15547
15548 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15549
15550 Example:
15551 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15552 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15553
15554fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15555 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15556 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15557 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15558 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
15559 MsgType, SenderComID, TargetComID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
15560 added.
15561
15562 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15563 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15564 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15565 fix_is_valid converter.
15566
15567 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15568
15569 Example:
15570 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15571 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15572 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15573 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15574 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15575
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015576hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015577 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015578 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015579 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015580 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015581
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015582hex2i
15583 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015584 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015585
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015586htonl
15587 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15588 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15589 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15590 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15591
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015592hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015593 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15594 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15595 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15596 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15597
15598 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15599 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15600
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015601http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015602 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15603 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015604 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15605 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15606 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15607 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15608 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15609 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15610 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15611 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015612
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015613iif(<true>,<false>)
15614 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15615 string otherwise.
15616
15617 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015618 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015619
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015620in_table(<table>)
15621 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15622 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15623 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015624 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015625 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15626
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015627ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015628 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015629 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015630 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15631 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15632 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15633 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15634 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015635
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015636json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015637 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015638 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015639 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015640 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15641 of errors:
15642 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15643 bytes, ...)
15644 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15645 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15646
15647 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15648 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15649 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15650 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15651 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15652 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015653 - "ascii" : never fails;
15654 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15655 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015656 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015657 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015658 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15659 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15660
15661 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015662 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015663
15664 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015665 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015666 capture request header user-agent len 150
15667 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015668
15669 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15670 GET / HTTP/1.0
15671 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15672
15673 Output log:
15674 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15675
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015676language(<value>[,<default>])
15677 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
15678 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
15679 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
15680 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
15681 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
15682 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
15683 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
15684 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
15685 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015686 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015687 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
15688 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015689
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015690 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015691
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015692 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
15693 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015694
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015695 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
15696 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
15697 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
15698 use_backend spanish if es
15699 use_backend french if fr
15700 use_backend english if en
15701 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020015702
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010015703length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010015704 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
15705 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15706 type. The result is of type integer.
15707
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015708lower
15709 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
15710 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15711 type. The result is of type string.
15712
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015713ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
15714 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15715 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
15716 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15717 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15718 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15719 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
15720
15721 Example :
15722
15723 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015724 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015725 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15726
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020015727ltrim(<chars>)
15728 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
15729 representation of the input sample.
15730
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015731map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15732map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15733map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
15734 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
15735 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15736 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15737 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15738 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15739 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15740 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15741 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015742
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015743 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15744 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15745 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015746
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015747 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015748 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015749
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015750 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15751 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15752 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15753 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015754 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15755 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015756 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15757 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15758 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15759 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15760 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15761 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15762 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15763 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015764 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15765 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15766 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015767 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15768 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15769 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15770 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15771 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015772
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015773 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15774 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15775 the corresponding match text.
15776
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015777 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15778 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15779 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15780 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15781 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015782
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015783 Example :
15784
15785 # this is a comment and is ignored
15786 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15787 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15788 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15789 | | | `---------- value
15790 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15791 | `---------------------------- key
15792 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15793
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015794mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015795 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15796 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015797 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015798 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015799 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015800 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15801 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15802 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15803 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015804 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015805 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015806
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010015807mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
15808 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
15809 <packettype>.
15810 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
15811 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
15812 from.
15813 Supported string and integers can be found here:
15814 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
15815 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
15816
15817 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
15818 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
15819 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
15820 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
15821
15822 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
15823 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
15824 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15825 packets only):
15826 17: Session Expiry Interval
15827 33: Receive Maximum
15828 39: Maximum Packet Size
15829 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15830 25: Request Response Information
15831 23: Request Problem Information
15832 21: Authentication Method
15833 22: Authentication Data
15834 18: Will Delay Interval
15835 1: Payload Format Indicator
15836 2: Message Expiry Interval
15837 3: Content Type
15838 8: Response Topic
15839 9: Correlation Data
15840 Not supported yet:
15841 38: User Property
15842
15843 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
15844 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
15845 packets only):
15846 17: Session Expiry Interval
15847 33: Receive Maximum
15848 36: Maximum QoS
15849 37: Retain Available
15850 39: Maximum Packet Size
15851 18: Assigned Client Identifier
15852 34: Topic Alias Maximum
15853 31: Reason String
15854 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
15855 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
15856 42: Shared Subscription Available
15857 19: Server Keep Alive
15858 26: Response Information
15859 28: Server Reference
15860 21: Authentication Method
15861 22: Authentication Data
15862 Not supported yet:
15863 38: User Property
15864
15865 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15866 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15867 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15868 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15869
15870 Example:
15871
15872 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15873 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15874 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
15875 if data_in_buffer
15876 # do the same as above
15877 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
15878 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
15879 if data_in_buffer
15880
15881mqtt_is_valid
15882 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
15883
15884 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15885 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
15886 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
15887 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
15888
15889 Example:
15890
15891 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
15892 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
15893
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015894mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015895 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015896 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15897 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015898 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015899 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015900 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015901 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15902 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15903 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015905 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015906 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015907
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015908nbsrv
15909 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15910 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15911 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15912 map lookup.
15913
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015914neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015915 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15916 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15917 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15918 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015919
15920not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015921 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015922 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015923 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015924 absence of a flag).
15925
15926odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015927 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015928 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15929
15930or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015931 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015932 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015933 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15934 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015935 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015936 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15937 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15938 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15939 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015940 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015941 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015942
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015943protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15944 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15945 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15946 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15947 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15948 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15949 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15950 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15951 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15952 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15953 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15954 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15955
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015956regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015957 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15958 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15959 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15960 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15961 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15962 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15963 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15964 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15965 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015966 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15967 of characters with other ones.
15968
15969 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15970 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15971 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15972 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15973 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15974 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015975
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015976 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015977
15978 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15979 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15980 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015981 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015982
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015983 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15984 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15985
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015986 # capture groups and backreferences
15987 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020015988 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015989 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15990
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015991capture-req(<id>)
15992 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15993 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15994
15995 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015996 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15997 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015998
15999capture-res(<id>)
16000 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16001 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16002
16003 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016004 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16005 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016006
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016007rtrim(<chars>)
16008 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16009 of the input sample.
16010
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016011sdbm([<avalanche>])
16012 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16013 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16014 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16015 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16016 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16017 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16018 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016019 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16020 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016021
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016022secure_memcmp(<var>)
16023 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16024 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16025 match.
16026
16027 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16028 performed in constant time.
16029
16030 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16031 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16032
16033 Example :
16034
16035 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16036 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16037 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16038 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16039
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016040set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016041 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16042 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16043 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016044 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016045 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16046 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016047 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016048 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16049 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016050 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016051 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016052
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016053sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016054 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016055 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16056
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016057sha2([<bits>])
16058 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16059 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16060
16061 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16062 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16063
16064 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16065 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16066
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016067srv_queue
16068 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16069 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16070 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16071 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16072 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16073
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016074strcmp(<var>)
16075 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16076 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16077 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16078 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16079 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16080 shorter).
16081
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016082 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16083 strings in constant time.
16084
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016085 Example :
16086
16087 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16088 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16089 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16090
16091
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016092sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016093 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16094 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016095 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016096 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16097 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016098 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016099 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16100 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016101 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016102 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16103 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016104 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016105 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016106
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016107table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16108 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16109 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16110 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16111 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16112 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16113 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16114
16115
16116table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16117 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16118 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16119 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16120 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16121 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16122 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16123
16124table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16125 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16126 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016127 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016128 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16129 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16130
16131table_conn_cur(<table>)
16132 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16133 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16134 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16135 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16136 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16137
16138table_conn_rate(<table>)
16139 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16140 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16141 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16142 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16143 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16144
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016145table_gpt0(<table>)
16146 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16147 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16148 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16149 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16150 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16151
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016152table_gpc0(<table>)
16153 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16154 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16155 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16156 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16157 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16158
16159table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16160 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16161 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16162 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16163 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16164 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16165 sample fetch keyword.
16166
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016167table_gpc1(<table>)
16168 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16169 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16170 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16171 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16172 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16173
16174table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16175 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16176 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16177 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16178 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16179 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16180 sample fetch keyword.
16181
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016182table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16183 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16184 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016185 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016186 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16187 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16188
16189table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16190 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16191 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16192 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16193 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16194 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16195 keyword.
16196
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016197table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16198 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16199 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16200 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16201 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16202 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16203
16204table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16205 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16206 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16207 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16208 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16209 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16210 keyword.
16211
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016212table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16213 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16214 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016215 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016216 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16217 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16218
16219table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16220 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16221 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16222 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16223 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16224 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16225 keyword.
16226
16227table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16228 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16229 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016230 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016231 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16232 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16233 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16234 keyword.
16235
16236table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16237 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16238 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016239 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016240 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16241 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16242 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16243 keyword.
16244
16245table_server_id(<table>)
16246 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16247 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16248 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16249 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16250 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16251 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16252
16253table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16254 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16255 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016256 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016257 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16258 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16259 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16260 keyword.
16261
16262table_sess_rate(<table>)
16263 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16264 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16265 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16266 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16267 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16268 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16269 keyword.
16270
16271table_trackers(<table>)
16272 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16273 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16274 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16275 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16276 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16277 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16278 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16279 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16280 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16281 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16282
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016283upper
16284 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16285 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16286 type. The result is of type string.
16287
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016288url_dec([<in_form>])
16289 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16290 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16291 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16292 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16293 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16294 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016295
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016296url_enc([<enc_type>])
16297 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16298 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16299 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16300 optional argument is here for future changes.
16301
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016302ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016303 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016304 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16305 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16306 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016307 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16308 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16309 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16310 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016311 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016312 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16313 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016314
16315 Example:
16316 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16317 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16318
16319 message Point {
16320 int32 latitude = 1;
16321 int32 longitude = 2;
16322 }
16323
16324 message PPoint {
16325 Point point = 59;
16326 }
16327
16328 message Rectangle {
16329 // One corner of the rectangle.
16330 PPoint lo = 48;
16331 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16332 PPoint hi = 49;
16333 }
16334
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016335 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16336 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16337 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016338
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016339 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16340 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016341 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016342 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16343
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016344 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016345
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016346 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016347
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016348 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16349 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16350 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016351
16352 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16353 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16354 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16355
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016356 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16357 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16358 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016359
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016360
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016361unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016362 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16363 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16364 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16365 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16366 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16367 response),
16368 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16369 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16370 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16371 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16372
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016373utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16374 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16375 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16376 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16377 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16378 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16379 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16380
16381 Example :
16382
16383 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016384 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016385 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16386
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016387word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16388 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16389 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16390 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016391 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016392 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16393 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16394
16395 Example :
16396 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16397 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16398 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16399 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16400 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016401 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016402
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016403wt6([<avalanche>])
16404 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16405 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16406 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16407 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16408 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16409 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16410 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016411 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16412 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016413
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016414xor(<value>)
16415 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016416 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016417 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016418 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016419 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016420 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16421 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016422 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016423 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16424 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016425 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016426 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016427
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016428xxh3([<seed>])
16429 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16430 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16431 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16432 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16433 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16434 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16435 considered as cryptographically secure.
16436
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016437xxh32([<seed>])
16438 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16439 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16440 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16441 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16442 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16443 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16444 as cryptographically secure.
16445
16446xxh64([<seed>])
16447 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16448 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16449 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16450 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16451 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16452 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16453 as cryptographically secure.
16454
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016455
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200164567.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016457--------------------------------------------
16458
16459A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16460not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16461"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16462The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16463
16464always_false : boolean
16465 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16466 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16467
16468always_true : boolean
16469 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16470 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16471
16472avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016473 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016474 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16475 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16476 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16477 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16478 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16479 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16480 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16481 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16482 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16483 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16484 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16485 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16486 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016488be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016489 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16490 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16491 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16492 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016493 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16494
16495be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16496 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16497 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16498 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16499 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16500 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016501 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16502 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016503
16504 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16505 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16506 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016508be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16509 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16510 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16511 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016512 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016513 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16514 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016515
16516 Example :
16517 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16518 backend dynamic
16519 mode http
16520 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16521 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016522
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016523bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016524 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16525 of the string.
16526
16527bool(<bool>) : bool
16528 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16529 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016531connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16532 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016533 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016534 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16535 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016536
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016537 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016538 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016539 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16540
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016541 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16542 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016543
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016544 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016545 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016546 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016547 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016548 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016549 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016550 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016551
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016552 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16553 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016554 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016555 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016556
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016557cpu_calls : integer
16558 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16559 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16560 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16561 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16562 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16563 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16564
16565cpu_ns_avg : integer
16566 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16567 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16568 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16569 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16570 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16571 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16572 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16573 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16574 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16575 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16576 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16577
16578cpu_ns_tot : integer
16579 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16580 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16581 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16582 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16583 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16584 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16585 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16586 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16587 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16588 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16589 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16590 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16591 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16592
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016593date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016594 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016595
16596 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16597 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16598 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016599 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16600
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016601 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16602 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16603 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16604 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16605 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16606
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016607 Example :
16608
16609 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16610 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016611
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016612 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16613 # millisecond granularity
16614 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16615
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016616date_us : integer
16617 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16618 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16619 from the same timeval structure.
16620
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016621distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16622 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16623 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16624 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16625 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16626 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16627 list of supported tokens.
16628
16629distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16630 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16631 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16632 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16633 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16634 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16635 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16636 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16637 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16638 supported tokens.
16639
16640 Example :
16641 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16642 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16643 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16644 # send large files to the big farm
16645 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16646
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016647env(<name>) : string
16648 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16649 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
16650 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
16651 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
16652 certain way.
16653
16654 Examples :
16655 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
16656 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
16657
16658 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
16659 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
16660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016661fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
16662 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016663 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
16664 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016665 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
16666 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016667 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016668 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
16669 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016670
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020016671fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16672 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
16673 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
16674 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
16675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016676fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
16677 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16678 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16679 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
16680 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
16681 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
16682 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
16683 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
16684 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016685
16686 Example :
16687 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
16688 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
16689 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
16690 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
16691 frontend mail
16692 bind :25
16693 mode tcp
16694 maxconn 100
16695 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
16696 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
16697 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
16698 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016699
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010016700hostname : string
16701 Returns the system hostname.
16702
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016703int(<integer>) : signed integer
16704 Returns a signed integer.
16705
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016706ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
16707 Returns an ipv4.
16708
16709ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
16710 Returns an ipv6.
16711
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016712lat_ns_avg : integer
16713 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16714 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16715 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16716 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16717 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16718 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16719 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16720 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16721 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016722 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16723 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16724 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16725 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16726 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
16727 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016728
16729lat_ns_tot : integer
16730 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
16731 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
16732 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
16733 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
16734 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
16735 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
16736 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
16737 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
16738 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020016739 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
16740 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
16741 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
16742 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
16743 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016744 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
16745 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
16746 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
16747 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
16748 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
16749 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
16750
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016751meth(<method>) : method
16752 Returns a method.
16753
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016754nbproc : integer
16755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
16756 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
16757 and debugging purposes.
16758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016759nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
16760 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
16761 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
16762 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016763 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
16764 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
16765 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016766
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040016767prio_class : integer
16768 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
16769 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
16770 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
16771
16772prio_offset : integer
16773 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
16774 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
16775 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
16776 set-priority-offset".
16777
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016778proc : integer
16779 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
16780 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
16781 debugging purposes.
16782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016783queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016784 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
16785 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
16786 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016787 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
16788 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
16789 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
16790 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
16791 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
16792
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010016793rand([<range>]) : integer
16794 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
16795 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
16796 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
16797 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
16798 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
16799
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020016800uuid([<version>]) : string
16801 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
16802 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
16803 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
16804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016805srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16806 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16807 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
16808 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
16809 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
16810 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016811 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
16812 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
16813
16814srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16815 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16816 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
16817 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16818 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
16819 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
16820 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
16821 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
16822
16823 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
16824 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825
16826srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
16827 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
16828 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
16829 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016830 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016831 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
16832 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
16833 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
16834
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020016835srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16836 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
16837 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
16838 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
16839 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
16840 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
16841 fetch methods.
16842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016843srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
16844 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16845 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016846 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016847 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
16848 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016849 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016850 overloading servers).
16851
16852 Example :
16853 # Redirect to a separate back
16854 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16855 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16856 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16857
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020016858srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16859 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
16860 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
16861 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
16862
16863srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16864 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
16865 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16866 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
16867
16868srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
16869 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
16870 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
16871 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
16872
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016873stopping : boolean
16874 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16875 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16876 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16877
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016878str(<string>) : string
16879 Returns a string.
16880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016881table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16882 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16883 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16884
16885table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16886 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16887 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16888 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16889
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016890thread : integer
16891 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16892 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16893 and debugging purposes.
16894
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016895var(<var-name>) : undefined
16896 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016897 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16898 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016899 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016900 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16901 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016902 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016903 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16904 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016905 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016906 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016907
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200169087.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016909----------------------------------
16910
16911The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16912closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16913methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16914sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16915TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016916the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16917counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016918"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16919used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16920can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16921Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16922table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16923tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16924currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016925
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016926bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016927 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16928 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16929 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016931be_id : integer
16932 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016933 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16934 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016935
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016936be_name : string
16937 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016938 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16939 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016940
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010016941be_server_timeout : integer
16942 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
16943 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
16944 also the "cur_server_timeout".
16945
16946be_tunnel_timeout : integer
16947 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
16948 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
16949 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
16950
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010016951cur_server_timeout : integer
16952 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
16953 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
16954 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
16955
16956cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
16957 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
16958 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
16959 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
16960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016961dst : ip
16962 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16963 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16964 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16965 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016966 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16967 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16968 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16969 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16970 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16971 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016972
16973dst_conn : integer
16974 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16975 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16976 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16977 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16978 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16979 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16980 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16981 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016982
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016983dst_is_local : boolean
16984 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16985 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16986 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16987 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016988 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016989 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16990 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16991 it only once per connection.
16992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016993dst_port : integer
16994 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16995 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16996 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16997 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16998 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16999 an HTTP header.
17000
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017001fc_http_major : integer
17002 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17003 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17004 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17005
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017006fc_pp_authority : string
17007 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17008 if any.
17009
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017010fc_pp_unique_id : string
17011 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17012 if any.
17013
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017014fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17015 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17016 header.
17017
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017018fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17019 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17020 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17021 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17022 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17023 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17024 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17025
17026fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17027 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17028 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17029 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17030 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17031 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17032 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17033
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017034fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017035 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17036 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17037 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17038 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17039
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017040fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017041 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17042 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17043 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17044 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17045
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017046fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017047 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17048 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17049 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17050 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17051
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017052fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017053 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17054 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17055 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17056 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17057
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017058fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017059 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17060 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17061 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17062 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17063
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017064fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017065 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17066 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17067 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17068 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17069
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017070fe_defbe : string
17071 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17072 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017074fe_id : integer
17075 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017076 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017077 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17078
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017079fe_name : string
17080 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17081 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17082 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17083
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017084fe_client_timeout : integer
17085 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17086 current frontend.
17087
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017088sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017089sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17090sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17091sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017092 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17093 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17094 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17095
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017096sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017097sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17098sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17099sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017100 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17101 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17102 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17103
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017104sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017105sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17106sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17107sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017108 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17109 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017110 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17111 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17112 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017113
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017114 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017115 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17116 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017117 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17118 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17119 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017120 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17121 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17122
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017123sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17124sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17125sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17126sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17127 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17128 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17129 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17130 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17131 when a first ACL was verified.
17132
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017133sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017134sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17135sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17136sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017137 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017138 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17139
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017140sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017141sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17142sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17143sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017144 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17145 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17146 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17147
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017148sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017149sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17150sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17151sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017152 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17153 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17154 See also src_conn_rate.
17155
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017156sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017157sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17158sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17159sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017160 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017161 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017162
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017163sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17164sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17165sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17166sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17167 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17168 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17169
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017170sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17171sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17172sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17173sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17174 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17175 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17176
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017177sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017178sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17179sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17180sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017181 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17182 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17183 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017184 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17185 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17186 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017187
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017188sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17189sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17190sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17191sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17192 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17193 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17194 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17195 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17196 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17197 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17198
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017199sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017200sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17201sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17202sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017203 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017204 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17205 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17206
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017207sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017208sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17209sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17210sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017211 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17212 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17213 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17214 src_http_err_rate.
17215
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017216sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17217sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17218sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17219sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17220 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17221 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17222 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17223
17224sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17225sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17226sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17227sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17228 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17229 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17230 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17231 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17232
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017233sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017234sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17235sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17236sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017237 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017238 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17239 src_http_req_cnt.
17240
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017241sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017242sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17243sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17244sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017245 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17246 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17247 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17248 src_http_req_rate.
17249
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017250sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017251sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17252sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17253sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017254 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017255 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17256 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17257 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17258 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017259
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017260 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017261 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17262 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017263 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17264
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017265sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17266sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17267sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17268sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17269 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17270 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17271 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17272 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17273 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17274
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017275sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017276sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17277sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17278sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017279 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17280 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17281 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017282
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017283sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017284sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17285sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17286sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017287 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17288 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17289 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017290
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017291sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017292sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17293sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17294sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017295 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017296 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17297 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17298 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017299 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017300 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17301
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017302sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017303sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17304sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17305sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017306 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17307 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17308 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17309 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17310 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017311 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017312
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017313sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017314sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17315sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17316sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017317 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17318 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17319 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17320
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017321sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017322sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17323sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17324sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017325 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17326 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017327 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017328 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17329 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017330 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17331 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17332 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017334so_id : integer
17335 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17336 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17337 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017338
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017339so_name : string
17340 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17341 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17342 strings instead of integers.
17343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017344src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017345 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017346 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17347 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17348 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017349 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17350 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17351 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017352 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17353 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17354 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17355 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17356 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17357 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17358 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017359
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017360 Example:
17361 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17362 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017364src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17365 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17366 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17367 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017368 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017370src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17371 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17372 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017373 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017374 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017376src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17377 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17378 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17379 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17380 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17381 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17382 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017383
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017384 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017385 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17386 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17387 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17388 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017389 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017390 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17391 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17392
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017393src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17394 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17395 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17396 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17397 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17398 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17399 was verified.
17400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017402 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017403 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017404 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017405 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017407src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017408 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017409 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17410 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017411 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017413src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17414 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17415 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17416 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017417 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017419src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017420 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017421 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017422 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017423 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017424
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017425src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17426 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17427 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17428 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17429 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17430
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017431src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17432 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17433 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17434 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17435 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017438 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017440 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17441 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017442 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17443 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17444 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017445
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017446src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17447 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17448 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17449 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17450 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17451 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17452 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17453 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017455src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017456 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017457 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017458 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017459 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017460 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017462src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17463 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17464 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17465 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17466 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017467 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017468
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017469src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17470 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17471 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17472 the designated stick-table. This includes the both repsonse errors and 5xx
17473 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17474 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17475
17476src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17477 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17478 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17479 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17480 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17481 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17482 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017484src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017485 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017486 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17487 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017488 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17491 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17492 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17493 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017494 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017495 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017497src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17498 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17499 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17500 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017501 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017502 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17503 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017504
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017505 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017506 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017507 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017508 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017509
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017510src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17511 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17512 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17513 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17514 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17515 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17516 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17517
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017518src_is_local : boolean
17519 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17520 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17521 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17522 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017523 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017524 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17525 once per connection.
17526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017527src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017528 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17529 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17530 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17531 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17532 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017534src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017535 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17536 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17537 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17538 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17539 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017540
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017541src_port : integer
17542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17543 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17544 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17545 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017547src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017548 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017549 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17550 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17551 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017552 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017554src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17555 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17556 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17557 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17558 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017559 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017561src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17562 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17563 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17564 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17565 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17566 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17567 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17568 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17569 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017570
17571 Example :
17572 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17573 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17574 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17575 listen ssh
17576 bind :22
17577 mode tcp
17578 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017579 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017580 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017581 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583srv_id : integer
17584 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17585 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017586 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017587
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017588srv_name : string
17589 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17590 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017591 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017592
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175937.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017596The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17597closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17598when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17599usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017600future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017601
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001760251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17603 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17604 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17605 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17606 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17607 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17608
17609 Example :
17610 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17611 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17612 # the request.
17613 frontend http-in
17614 bind *:8081
17615 default_backend servers
17616 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17617 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17618
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017619ssl_bc : boolean
17620 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17621 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017622 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17623 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017624
17625ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17626 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017627 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17628 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017629
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017630ssl_bc_alpn : string
17631 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
17632 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017633 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017634 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17635 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17636 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
17637 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
17638 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017639 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
17640 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017641
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017642ssl_bc_cipher : string
17643 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017644 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17645 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017646
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017647ssl_bc_client_random : binary
17648 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17649 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17650 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017651 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017652
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017653ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
17654 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17655 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017656 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17657 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010017658
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017659ssl_bc_npn : string
17660 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
17661 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020017662 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017663 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
17664 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
17665 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
17666 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017667 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
17668 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010017669
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017670ssl_bc_protocol : string
17671 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017672 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17673 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017674
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017675ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017676 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017677 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017678 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
17679 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017680
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017681ssl_bc_server_random : binary
17682 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
17683 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17684 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017685 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017686
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017687ssl_bc_session_id : binary
17688 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
17689 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017690 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
17691 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017692
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017693ssl_bc_session_key : binary
17694 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
17695 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17696 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017697 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017698
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017699ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
17700 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017701 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17702 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017704ssl_c_ca_err : integer
17705 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17706 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
17707 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
17708 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
17709 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017711ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
17712 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17713 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
17714 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
17715 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017716
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017717ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017718 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
17719 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17720 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017721 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020017722 does not support resumed sessions.
17723
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010017724ssl_c_der : binary
17725 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
17726 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17727 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017729ssl_c_err : integer
17730 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17731 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
17732 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
17733 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
17734 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017735
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017736ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017737 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17738 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17739 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17740 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17741 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17742 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17743 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17744 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017745 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17746 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17747 LDAP v3.
17748 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17749 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017751ssl_c_key_alg : string
17752 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17753 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17754 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017756ssl_c_notafter : string
17757 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
17758 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17759 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020017760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017761ssl_c_notbefore : string
17762 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
17763 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17764 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017765
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017766ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017767 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17768 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17769 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17770 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17771 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17772 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17773 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17774 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017775 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17776 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17777 LDAP v3.
17778 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17779 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010017780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017781ssl_c_serial : binary
17782 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
17783 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17784 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017786ssl_c_sha1 : binary
17787 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
17788 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
17789 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017790 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
17791 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
17792
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017793 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020017794 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017796ssl_c_sig_alg : string
17797 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17798 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17799 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017801ssl_c_used : boolean
17802 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
17803 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017805ssl_c_verify : integer
17806 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
17807 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
17808 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
17809 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017811ssl_c_version : integer
17812 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
17813 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017814
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010017815ssl_f_der : binary
17816 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
17817 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17818 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17819
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017820ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017821 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17822 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17823 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17824 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017825 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017826 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17827 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17828 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017829 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17830 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17831 LDAP v3.
17832 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17833 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017835ssl_f_key_alg : string
17836 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17837 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
17838 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017840ssl_f_notafter : string
17841 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17842 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17843 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845ssl_f_notbefore : string
17846 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
17847 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17848 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017849
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017850ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017851 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17852 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17853 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17854 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17855 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17856 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
17857 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17858 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050017859 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17860 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17861 LDAP v3.
17862 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17863 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020017864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017865ssl_f_serial : binary
17866 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17867 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17868 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020017869
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020017870ssl_f_sha1 : binary
17871 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
17872 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17873 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017875ssl_f_sig_alg : string
17876 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17877 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17878 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020017879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017880ssl_f_version : integer
17881 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
17882 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17883
17884ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017885 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17886 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
17887 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
17888
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017889 Example :
17890 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
17891 listen http-https
17892 bind :80
17893 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
17894 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
17895
17896ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
17897 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
17898 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
17899
17900ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017901 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017902 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
17903 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
17904 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
17905 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
17906 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
17907 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
17908 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
17909 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
17910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017911ssl_fc_cipher : string
17912 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
17913 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020017914
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017915ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
17916 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
17917 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017918 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017919
17920ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
17921 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
17922 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017923 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017924
17925ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
17926 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
17927 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
17928 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017929 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020017930 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017931
17932ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17933 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17934 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017935 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017936
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017937ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17938 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17939 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17940 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17941
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020017942ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
17943 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17944 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17945 transport layer.
17946 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17947 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17948 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17949 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17950
17951ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
17952 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17953 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17954 transport layer.
17955 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17956 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17957 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17958 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17959
17960ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
17961 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
17962 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17963 transport layer.
17964 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17965 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17966 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17967 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17968
17969ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
17970 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17971 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
17972 transport layer.
17973 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17974 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17975 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17976 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17977
17978ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
17979 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
17980 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
17981 transport layer.
17982 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
17983 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
17984 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
17985 "tune.ssl.keylog"
17986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017987ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017988 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17989 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017990 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17991 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17992 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17993 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017994
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017995ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17996 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17997 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17998 wait until the handshake happened.
17999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018000ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18001 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018002 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18003 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018004 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018005 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018006
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018007ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018008 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018009 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18010 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018012ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018013 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018014 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18015 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18016 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18017 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18018 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18019 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18020 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022ssl_fc_protocol : string
18023 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18024 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018025
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018026ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018027 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018028 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18029 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018030
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018031ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18032 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18033 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18034 transport layer.
18035 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18036 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18037 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18038 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18039
18040ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18041 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18042 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18043 transport layer.
18044 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18045 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18046 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18047 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18048
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018049ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18050 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18051 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18052 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18053
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018054ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18055 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18056 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18057 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18058 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018059
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018060ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18061 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18062 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18063 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18064 BoringSSL.
18065
18066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018067ssl_fc_sni : string
18068 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18069 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18070 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18071 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18072 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18073
18074 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18075 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18076 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018077 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018078 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018080 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18082 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018084ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18085 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18086 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018087
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018088ssl_s_der : binary
18089 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18090 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18091 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18092
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018093ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18094 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18095 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18096 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018097 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018098 does not support resumed sessions.
18099
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018100ssl_s_key_alg : string
18101 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18102 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18103 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18104
18105ssl_s_notafter : string
18106 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18107 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18108 transport layer.
18109
18110ssl_s_notbefore : string
18111 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18112 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18113 transport layer.
18114
18115ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18116 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18117 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18118 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18119 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18120 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18121 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018122 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18123 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018124 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18125 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18126 LDAP v3.
18127 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18128 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18129
18130ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18131 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18132 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18133 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18134 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18135 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18136 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018137 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18138 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018139 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18140 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18141 LDAP v3.
18142 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18143 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18144
18145ssl_s_serial : binary
18146 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18147 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18148 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18149
18150ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18151 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18152 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18153 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18154
18155ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18156 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18157 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18158 layer.
18159
18160ssl_s_version : integer
18161 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18162 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018163
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200181647.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018165------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018166
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018167Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18168sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18169only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18170For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18171be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18172can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18173sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18174for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18175content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018177payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018178 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018179 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18180 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018182payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18183 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018184 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018185 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018187req.len : integer
18188req_len : integer (deprecated)
18189 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18190 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18191 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18192 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18193 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18194 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18195 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18196 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018198req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18199 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018200 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18201 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18202 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18203 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018205 ACL alternatives :
18206 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018208req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18209 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18210 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18211 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18212 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018214 ACL alternatives :
18215 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018219req.proto_http : boolean
18220req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18221 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18222 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18223 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18224 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18225 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18226 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18227 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018228
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018229 Example:
18230 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18231 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18232 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018233 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18236rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18237 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18238 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18239 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18240 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18241 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18242 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18243 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18246 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18247 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18248 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18249 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18250 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018252 ACL derivatives :
18253 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018255 Example :
18256 listen tse-farm
18257 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18258 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18259 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18260 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18261 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18262 persist rdp-cookie
18263 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18264 # This is only useful makes sense if
18265 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18266 stick-table type string size 204800
18267 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18268 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18269 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018271 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18272 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018274req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18275rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18276 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18277 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18278 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18279 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018281 ACL derivatives :
18282 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018283
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018284req.ssl_alpn : string
18285 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18286 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18287 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18288 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18289 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18290 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018291 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018292
18293 Examples :
18294 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18295 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18296 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018297 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018298 default_backend bk_default
18299
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018300req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18301 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18302 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018303 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18304 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18305 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18306 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18307 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018309req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18310req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18311 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18312 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18313 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18314 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18315 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18316 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18317 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018319req.ssl_sni : string
18320req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18321 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18322 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18323 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18324 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18325 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018326 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18327 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18328 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18329 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18330 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18331 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18332 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18333 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18334 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018335
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018336 ACL derivatives :
18337 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018338
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018339 Examples :
18340 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18341 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18342 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18343 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18344 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018345
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018346req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18347 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18348 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18349 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18350 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18351 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18352 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18353 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18354 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18355 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357req.ssl_ver : integer
18358req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18359 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18360 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18361 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18362 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18363 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18364 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18365 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018366 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018367 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018368
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018369 ACL derivatives :
18370 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018371
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018372res.len : integer
18373 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18374 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18375 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18376 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18377 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18378 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18379 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018380 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18383 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018384 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018385 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018386 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018387 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018389res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18390 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18391 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18392 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018393 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18394 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018396 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018397
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018398res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18399rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18400 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18401 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18402 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18403 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18404 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18405 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18406 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018408wait_end : boolean
18409 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18410 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018411 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018412 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18413 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018414 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018415 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18416 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018418 Examples :
18419 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18420 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18421 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018423 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18424 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18425 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18426 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18427 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18428 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18429 tcp-request content reject
18430
18431
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200184327.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018433--------------------------------------
18434
18435It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18436This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18437data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18438its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18439HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18440content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18441to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18442more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18443response are indexed.
18444
18445base : string
18446 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18447 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18448 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18449 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18450 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18451 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18452 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18453 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18454
18455 ACL derivatives :
18456 base : exact string match
18457 base_beg : prefix match
18458 base_dir : subdir match
18459 base_dom : domain match
18460 base_end : suffix match
18461 base_len : length match
18462 base_reg : regex match
18463 base_sub : substring match
18464
18465base32 : integer
18466 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18467 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18468 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018469 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18470 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18471 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472
18473base32+src : binary
18474 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18475 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18476 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18477 per-URL counters.
18478
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018479capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18480 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18481 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18482 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18483
18484capture.req.method : string
18485 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18486 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18487 because it's allocated.
18488
18489capture.req.uri : string
18490 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18491 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18492 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18493 allocated.
18494
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018495capture.req.ver : string
18496 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18497 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18498 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18499
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018500capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18501 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18502 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18503 The first entry is an index of 0.
18504 See also: "capture response header"
18505
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018506capture.res.ver : string
18507 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18508 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18509 persistent flag.
18510
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018511req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018512 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18513 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18514 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018515
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018516req.body_param([<name>) : string
18517 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18518 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18519 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18520 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18521 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18522 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18523 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18524 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18525 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18526 given.
18527
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018528req.body_len : integer
18529 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18530 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018531 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18532 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018533
18534req.body_size : integer
18535 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018536 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18537 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018539req.cook([<name>]) : string
18540cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18541 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18542 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18543 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18544 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18545 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18546 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18547 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18548 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18549
18550 ACL derivatives :
18551 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18552 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18553 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18554 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18555 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18556 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18557 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18558 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018560req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18561cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18562 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18563 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18566cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18567 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18568 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18569 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18570 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018572cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18573 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18574 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18575 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18576 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018577 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018578 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18579 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18580 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18581 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18584 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18585 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18586 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18587 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018588 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018590req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018591 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18592 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18593 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18594 with headers such as User-Agent.
18595
18596 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18597 found.
18598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018599 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18600 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18601 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018602 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018603
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018604req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18605 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18606 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018607 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
18608 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018610req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018611 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
18612 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
18613 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
18614 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
18615 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
18616 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
18617 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
18618
18619 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18620 found.
18621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018622 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18623 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18624 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018625 with -1 being the last one.
18626
18627 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
18628 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018630 ACL derivatives :
18631 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18632 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18633 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18634 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18635 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18636 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18637 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18638 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18639
18640req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18641hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
18642 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18643 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018644 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
18645 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
18646 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
18647
18648 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
18649 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
18650 which contain more than one of certain headers.
18651
18652 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018653
18654req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18655hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
18656 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
18657 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
18658 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018659 of every header is checked.
18660
18661 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18662
18663 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018664
18665req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18666hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
18667 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
18668 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
18669 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018670
18671 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
18672
18673 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018674
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018675req.hdrs : string
18676 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
18677 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18678 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
18679 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18680
18681req.hdrs_bin : binary
18682 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18683 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
18684 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
18685 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
18686 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
18687 names and values (length of 0 for both).
18688
18689 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018690
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010018691 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18692 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010018693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018694http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
18695 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
18696 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
18697 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18698 basic auth is supported.
18699
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018700http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
18701 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
18702 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
18703 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
18704 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
18706 basic auth is supported.
18707
18708 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010018709 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
18710 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
18711 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
18712 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018713
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018714http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018715 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
18716 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18717 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018718
18719http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018720 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
18721 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
18722 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018723
18724http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010018725 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
18726 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
18727 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020018728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018729http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018730 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
18731 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018732 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
18733 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020018734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018735method : integer + string
18736 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
18737 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
18738 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
18739 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
18740 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
18741 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
18742 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018744 ACL derivatives :
18745 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018747 Example :
18748 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
18749 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
18750 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018752path : string
18753 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
18754 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
18755 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
18756 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
18757 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018758 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018761 ACL derivatives :
18762 path : exact string match
18763 path_beg : prefix match
18764 path_dir : subdir match
18765 path_dom : domain match
18766 path_end : suffix match
18767 path_len : length match
18768 path_reg : regex match
18769 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018770
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020018771pathq : string
18772 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
18773 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
18774 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
18775 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
18776 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
18777 result in both cases.
18778
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018779query : string
18780 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
18781 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
18782 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
18783 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018784 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010018785 which stops before the question mark.
18786
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018787req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18788 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18789 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18790 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
18791 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018793req.ver : string
18794req_ver : string (deprecated)
18795 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
18796 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
18797 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018798
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799 ACL derivatives :
18800 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018801
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018802res.body : binary
18803 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
18804 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018805 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18806
18807 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018808
18809res.body_len : integer
18810 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
18811 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018812 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18813
18814 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018815
18816res.body_size : integer
18817 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
18818 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18819 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
18820 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018821 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
18822
18823 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018824
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010018825res.cache_hit : boolean
18826 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
18827 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
18828
18829res.cache_name : string
18830 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
18831 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
18832 empty string.
18833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018834res.comp : boolean
18835 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
18836 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
18837 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018839res.comp_algo : string
18840 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
18841 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
18842 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018844res.cook([<name>]) : string
18845scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18846 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18847 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018848 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18849
18850 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018852 ACL derivatives :
18853 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020018854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018855res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18856scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18857 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18858 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018859 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
18860
18861 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018862
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018863res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18864scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18865 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18866 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018867 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
18868
18869 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018871res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018872 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18873 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18874
18875 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
18876 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
18877
18878 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
18879
18880 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018882res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018883 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18884 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18885
18886 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
18887 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
18888
18889 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018891res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18892shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018893 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
18894 on the headers within an HTTP response.
18895
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050018896 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018897 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
18898
18899 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018900
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018901 ACL derivatives :
18902 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
18903 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
18904 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
18905 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
18906 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
18907 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
18908 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
18909 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
18910
18911res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18912shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018913 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
18914 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18915
18916 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050018917 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018918
18919 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018921res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
18922shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018923 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
18924 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18925
18926 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18927
18928 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018929
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018930res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
18931 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
18932 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
18933 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018934 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
18935
18936 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010018937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018938res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
18939shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018940 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
18941 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
18942
18943 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
18944
18945 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018946
18947res.hdrs : string
18948 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
18949 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
18950 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018951 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
18952
18953 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018954
18955res.hdrs_bin : binary
18956 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
18957 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
18958 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
18959 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
18960 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
18961 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
18962 (length of 0 for both).
18963
18964 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
18965
18966 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
18967 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018969res.ver : string
18970resp_ver : string (deprecated)
18971 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018972 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
18973
18974 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018976 ACL derivatives :
18977 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010018978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018979set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18980 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
18981 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018982 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018983 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018985 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
18986 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018988status : integer
18989 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
18990 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018991 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
18992
18993 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018994
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020018995unique-id : string
18996 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
18997 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
18998 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
18999 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19000 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19001 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019003url : string
19004 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19005 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19006 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19007 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19008 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19009 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19010 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019012 ACL derivatives :
19013 url : exact string match
19014 url_beg : prefix match
19015 url_dir : subdir match
19016 url_dom : domain match
19017 url_end : suffix match
19018 url_len : length match
19019 url_reg : regex match
19020 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019022url_ip : ip
19023 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19024 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19025 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19026 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19027 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19028 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19029 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019031url_port : integer
19032 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19033 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19034 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19035 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019036
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019037urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19038url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019039 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19040 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019041 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19042 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19043 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19044 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019045 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19046 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019047 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19048 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019050 ACL derivatives :
19051 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19052 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19053 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19054 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19055 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19056 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19057 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19058 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019059
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019061 Example :
19062 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19063 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19064 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19065 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019066
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019067urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019068 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19069 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19070 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019071
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019072url32 : integer
19073 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19074 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19075 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19076 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19077 is an unsigned integer.
19078
19079url32+src : binary
19080 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19081 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19082 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19083
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019084
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200190857.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019086---------------------------------------
19087
19088This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19089used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19090purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19091There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19092or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19093any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19094for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19095
19096internal.htx.data : integer
19097 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19098 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19099
19100internal.htx.free : integer
19101 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19102 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19103
19104internal.htx.free_data : integer
19105 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19106 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19107
19108internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019109 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19110 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19111 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019112
19113internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19114 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19115 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19116
19117internal.htx.size : integer
19118 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19119 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19120
19121internal.htx.used : integer
19122 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19123 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19124 direction.
19125
19126internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19127 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19128 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19129 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19130 of the special value :
19131 * head : The oldest inserted block
19132 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019133 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019134
19135internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19136 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19137 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19138 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19139 integer or one of the special value :
19140 * head : The oldest inserted block
19141 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019142 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019143
19144internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19145 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19146 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19147 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19148 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19149
19150 * head : The oldest inserted block
19151 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019152 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019153
19154internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19155 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19156 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19157 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19158 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19159
19160 * head : The oldest inserted block
19161 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019162 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019163
19164internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19165 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19166 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19167 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19168 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19169
19170 * head : The oldest inserted block
19171 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019172 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019173
19174internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19175 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19176 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19177 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19178 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19179
19180 * head : The oldest inserted block
19181 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019182 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019183
19184internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19185 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19186 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19187 it returns false.
19188
19189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200191907.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019191---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019192
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019193Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19194every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019195order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019197ACL name Equivalent to Usage
19198---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019199FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020019200HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019201HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
19202HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019203HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
19204HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19205HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19206HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19207LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019208METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019209METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019210METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19211METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19212METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19213METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020019214METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019215METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019216RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019217REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019218TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019219WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19220---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019221
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019222
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192238. Logging
19224----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019225
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019226One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19227provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19228very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19229provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19230state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019231to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019232headers.
19233
19234In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19235about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19236send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19237
19238 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19239 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19240 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19241 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19242 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019243 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019244 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019245
19246The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19247allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19248as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19249while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19250real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19251delay.
19252
19253
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192548.1. Log levels
19255---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019256
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019257TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019258source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019259HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19260in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19261track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19262syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19263about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019264
19265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192668.2. Log formats
19267----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019268
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019269HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019270and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19271slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19272options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019273
19274 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19275 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19276 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19277 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19278 extents.
19279
19280 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19281 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19282 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19283 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19284 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19285
19286 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19287 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19288 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19289 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19290 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19291
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019292 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19293 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19294 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19295 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19296
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019297 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019299Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19300specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19301field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19302servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19303always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19304identifier.
19305
19306Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19307 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19308 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19309 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19310 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19311
19312
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193138.2.1. Default log format
19314-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019315
19316This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19317as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19318format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19319
19320 Example :
19321 listen www
19322 mode http
19323 log global
19324 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19325
19326 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19327 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19328 (www/HTTP)
19329
19330 Field Format Extract from the example above
19331 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19332 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19333 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19334 4 'to' to
19335 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19336 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19337
19338Detailed fields description :
19339 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19340 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19341 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19342 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19343 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19344 and processed the connection.
19345 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19346
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019347In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19348"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19349connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19350
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019351It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19352will eventually disappear.
19353
19354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200193558.2.2. TCP log format
19356---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019357
19358The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19359is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19360information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19361counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19362emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19363environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19364the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19365sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019366specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19367not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19368fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19369marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019370
19371 Example :
19372 frontend fnt
19373 mode tcp
19374 option tcplog
19375 log global
19376 default_backend bck
19377
19378 backend bck
19379 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19380
19381 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19382 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19383 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19384
19385 Field Format Extract from the example above
19386 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19387 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19388 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19389 4 frontend_name fnt
19390 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19391 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19392 7 bytes_read* 212
19393 8 termination_state --
19394 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19395 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19396
19397Detailed fields description :
19398 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019399 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19400 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19401 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019402 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019403 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019404 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019405
19406 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019407 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19408 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19409 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019410
19411 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19412 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19413 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019414 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19415 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19416 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19417 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019418
19419 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19420 and processed the connection.
19421
19422 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19423 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19424 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19425 applications.
19426
19427 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19428 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19429 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19430 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19431 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19432
19433 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19434 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19435 See "Timers" below for more details.
19436
19437 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19438 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19439 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19440 "Timers" below for more details.
19441
19442 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019443 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019444 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19445 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19446 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19447 details.
19448
19449 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19450 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19451 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19452 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19453 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19454
19455 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19456 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19457 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19458 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19459 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19460 for more details.
19461
19462 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019463 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019464 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19465 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19466 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019467 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019468
19469 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19470 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19471 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19472 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19473 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19474 caused by a denial of service attack.
19475
19476 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19477 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19478 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19479 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19480 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19481 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19482 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19483 denial of service attack.
19484
19485 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19486 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19487 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19488 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19489 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19490 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19491 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19492 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19493 be processed than on other servers.
19494
19495 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19496 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19497 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19498 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19499 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19500 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19501 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19502 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19503 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19504 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19505 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19506 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19507 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19508
19509 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19510 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19511 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19512 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19513 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19514 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019515 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019516 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19517
19518 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19519 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19520 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19521 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19522 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19523 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019524 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019525 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19526 occurs.
19527
19528
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195298.2.3. HTTP log format
19530----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019531
19532The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19533is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19534the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19535are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19536emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19537generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19538"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19539which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019540frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19541is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019542
19543Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19544slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19545with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19546
19547 Example :
19548 frontend http-in
19549 mode http
19550 option httplog
19551 log global
19552 default_backend bck
19553
19554 backend static
19555 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19556
19557 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19558 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19559 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019560 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019561
19562 Field Format Extract from the example above
19563 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19564 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019565 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019566 4 frontend_name http-in
19567 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019568 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019569 7 status_code 200
19570 8 bytes_read* 2750
19571 9 captured_request_cookie -
19572 10 captured_response_cookie -
19573 11 termination_state ----
19574 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19575 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19576 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19577 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19578 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019579
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019580Detailed fields description :
19581 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019582 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19583 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19584 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019585 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019586 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019587 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019588
19589 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019590 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19591 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19592 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019593
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019594 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19595 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019596
19597 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19598 and processed the connection.
19599
19600 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19601 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19602 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
19603
19604 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19605 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19606 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19607 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
19608 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
19609 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
19610
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019611 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
19612 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
19613 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019614 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019615 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
19616 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019617 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
19618 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019619
19620 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19621 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019622 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019623
19624 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19625 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019626 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
19627 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019628
19629 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
19630 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
19631 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
19632 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
19633 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019634 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
19635 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019636
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019637 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
19638 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
19639 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
19640 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
19641 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
19642 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
19643 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019644 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019645
19646 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
19647 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
19648 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
19649
19650 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
19651 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019652 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019653 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
19654 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
19655 overflowing.
19656
19657 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
19658 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
19659 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
19660 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
19661 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
19662 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
19663 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
19664 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19665
19666 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
19667 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
19668 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
19669 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
19670 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
19671 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
19672 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
19673 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
19674
19675 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19676 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19677 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
19678 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
19679 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
19680 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
19681 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
19682
19683 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019684 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019685 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
19686 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
19687 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019688 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019689 system.
19690
19691 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19692 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19693 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19694 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19695 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19696 caused by a denial of service attack.
19697
19698 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19699 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19700 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19701 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19702 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19703 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19704 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19705 denial of service attack.
19706
19707 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19708 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19709 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19710 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19711 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19712 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19713 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19714 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
19715 processed than on other servers.
19716
19717 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19718 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19719 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19720 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19721 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19722 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19723 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19724 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19725 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19726 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19727 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19728 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19729 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19730
19731 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19732 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19733 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19734 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19735 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19736 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019737 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019738 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19739
19740 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19741 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19742 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19743 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19744 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19745 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019746 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019747 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19748 occurs.
19749
19750 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
19751 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
19752 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
19753 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
19754 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
19755 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
19756 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
19757 cookies" below for more details.
19758
19759 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
19760 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
19761 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
19762 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
19763 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
19764 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
19765 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
19766 and cookies" below for more details.
19767
19768 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
19769 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
19770 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
19771 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
19772 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
19773 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
19774 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
19775 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
19776
19777
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200197788.2.4. Custom log format
19779------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019780
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019781The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019782mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019783
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019784HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019785Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
19786separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
19787prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
19788
19789Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
19790variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019791("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019792
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019793If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020019794as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010019795less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
19796the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
19797
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020019798Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
19799"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
19800delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
19801preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019802
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019803Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
19804'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
19805https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
19806such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
19807
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019808Flags are :
19809 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019810 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019811 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
19812 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019813
19814 Example:
19815
19816 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
19817 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
19818
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010019819 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
19820
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019821At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
19822
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019823 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
19824 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019825
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019826the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019827
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019828 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
19829 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
19830 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019831
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019832and the default TCP format is defined this way :
19833
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019834 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
19835 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019836
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019837Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
19838
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019839 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019840 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019841 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
19842 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
19843 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019844 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
19845 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
19846 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019847 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019848 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000019849 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000019850 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000019851 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000019852 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
19853 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010019854 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020019855 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019856 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019857 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019858 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020019859 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080019860 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019861 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
19862 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
19863 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
19864 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
19865 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019866 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019867 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019868 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019869 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019870 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019871 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
19872 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019873 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19874 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
19875 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019876 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019877 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
19878 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019879 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019880 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
19881 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
19882 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020019883 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020019884 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019885 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
19886 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
19887 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
19888 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020019889 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020019890 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019891 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019892 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010019893 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019894 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019895 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
19896 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
19897 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019898 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019899 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
19900 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010019901 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019902 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
19903 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020019904 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019905 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019906 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010019907 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019908
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020019909 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019910
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019911
199128.2.5. Error log format
19913-----------------------
19914
19915When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
19916protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
19917By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
19918"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019919will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010019920logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
19921
19922The format looks like this :
19923
19924 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
19925 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
19926 Connection error during SSL handshake
19927
19928 Field Format Extract from the example above
19929 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
19930 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
19931 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
19932 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
19933 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
19934
19935These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
19936failures.
19937
19938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199398.3. Advanced logging options
19940-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019941
19942Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
19943just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
19944options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
19945for more information about their usage.
19946
19947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199488.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
19949------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019950
19951It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
19952haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
19953commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
19954monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
19955ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
19956
19957 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
19958 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
19959 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
19960 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
19961
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020019962 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
19963 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019964
19965 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
19966 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
19967 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
19968
19969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199708.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
19971----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019972
19973The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
19974what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
19975or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019976"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019977just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
19978log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
19979after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
19980is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
19981with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
19982with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
19983
19984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199858.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
19986------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019987
19988Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
19989for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
19990"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
19991retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
19992raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
19993a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
19994file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
19995you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
19996"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
19997
19998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199998.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20000--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020001
20002Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20003multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20004them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20005"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20006logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20007error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20008and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20009too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20010useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20011alternative.
20012
20013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200148.4. Timing events
20015------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020016
20017Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20018reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20019the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20020frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020021mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20022addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20023
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020024Timings events in HTTP mode:
20025
20026 first request 2nd request
20027 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20028 t tr t tr ...
20029 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20030 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20031 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20032 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020033 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020034 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20035
20036Timings events in TCP mode:
20037
20038 TCP session
20039 |<----------------->|
20040 t t
20041 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20042 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20043 |<------ Tt ------->|
20044
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020045 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020046 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020047 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20048 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20049 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020050 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020051 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20052 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20053 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20054 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020055
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020056 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20057 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20058 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020059 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20060 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20061 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20062 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20063 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20064 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020065
20066 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20067 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20068 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20069 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20070 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20071 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20072 request typed by hand during a test.
20073
20074 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20075 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020076 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020077 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20078 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20079 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20080 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020081
20082 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20083 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20084 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20085 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20086 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20087
20088 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20089 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20090 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20091 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20092 connection never established.
20093
20094 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20095 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20096 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20097 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20098 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20099 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20100 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20101 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20102 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20103 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20104 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20105
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020106 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20107 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20108 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20109 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20110 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20111 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20112
20113 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20114
20115 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20116 "Ta" can never be negative.
20117
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020118 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20119 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020120 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20121 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020122 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020123
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020124 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020125
20126 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020127 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20128 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020129
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020130 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20131 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20132 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20133 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20134 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20135 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20136 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20137 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20138
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020139These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20140protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20141that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020142due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20143"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20144that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020145
20146Most common cases :
20147
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020148 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20149 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20150 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20151 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20152 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20153 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20154 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20155 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20156 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20157 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20158 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020159 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020160
20161 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20162 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20163 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20164 of ms on remote networks.
20165
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020166 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20167 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20168 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020169
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020170 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20171 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20172 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20173 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20174 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20175 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20176 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20177 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20178 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020179
20180Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20181
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020182 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020183 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020184 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020185
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020186 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020187 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20188 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20189
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020190 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020191 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20192 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20193 flags.
20194
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020195 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20196 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020197 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20198 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20199 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20200 the client connection was maintained open.
20201
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020202 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020203 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020204 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020205 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20206
20207
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200202088.5. Session state at disconnection
20209-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020210
20211TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20212"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
202132-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20214each of which has a special meaning :
20215
20216 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20217 session to terminate :
20218
20219 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20220
20221 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20222 server explicitly refused it.
20223
20224 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20225 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20226 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20227 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020228 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020229
20230 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20231 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020232
20233 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20234 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20235 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20236 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20237 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20238
20239 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20240 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20241 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20242 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20243 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20244
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020245 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20246 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20247
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020248 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20249 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20250 backup connections when going up.
20251
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020252 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20253
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020254 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20255 send or receive data.
20256
20257 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20258 send or receive data.
20259
20260 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20261 with nothing left in the buffers.
20262
20263 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20264
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020265 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020266 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20267
20268 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20269 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20270 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20271 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20272 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20273
20274 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20275 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20276
20277 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20278 server (HTTP only).
20279
20280 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20281
20282 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20283 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20284 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20285
20286 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20287 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20288 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20289
20290 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20291
20292 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20293 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20294
20295 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20296 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20297 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20298
20299 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20300 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020301 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20302 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020303
20304 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20305 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20306 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20307 another server.
20308
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020309 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020310 server.
20311
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020312 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20313 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20314 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20315 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20316
20317 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20318 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20319 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20320 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20321
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020322 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20323 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20324 "use-server" rule).
20325
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020326 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20327
20328 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20329 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20330
20331 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20332
20333 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20334 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20335 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20336
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020337 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20338 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020339 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020340 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20341 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20342
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020343 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20344
20345 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20346 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20347
20348 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20349
20350 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20351
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020352The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20353was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020354helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20355starvation, attacks, etc...
20356
20357The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20358alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20359easier finding and understanding.
20360
20361 Flags Reason
20362
20363 -- Normal termination.
20364
20365 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20366 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20367 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20368 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20369
20370 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20371 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20372 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20373 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20374 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20375 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020376
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020377 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20378 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020379 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020380
20381 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20382 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20383 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20384
20385 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20386 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20387 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20388 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20389 the server takes too long to respond.
20390
20391 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20392 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20393 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20394 long a time to respond.
20395
20396 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20397 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20398 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20399 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020400 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20401 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020402
20403 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20404 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20405 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20406 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20407 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020408 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020409 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20410 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20411 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20412 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20413 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20414 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20415 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20416 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020417 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020418 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20419 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20420 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020421
20422 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20423 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020424 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20425 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20426 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20427 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020428
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020429 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20430 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20431
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020432 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020433 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20434 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020435 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020436 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20437 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20438
20439 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20440 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20441 503 or 504 here.
20442
20443 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20444 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20445 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20446 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20447 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20448
20449 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20450 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020451 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020452 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20453 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20454
20455 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20456 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20457 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20458 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20459 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20460 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20461 between haproxy and the server.
20462
20463 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20464 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20465 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20466 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20467 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20468 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20469 solution is to fix the application.
20470
20471 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20472 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20473 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20474 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20475 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20476 external attacks.
20477
20478 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020479 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020480 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020481 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20482 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20483
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020484 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20485 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20486 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020487 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020488 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020489
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020490 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20491 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20492 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20493 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020494 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20495 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20496 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20497 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20498 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020499
20500 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20501 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20502 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20503 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20504
20505 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20506 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20507 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20508 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20509
20510 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20511 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20512 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20513 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20514
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020515The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20516persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20517important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20518re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20519
20520 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20521
20522 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20523 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20524 set on a GET request.
20525
20526 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20527 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020528 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020529 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20530
20531 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20532 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20533 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20534
20535 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20536 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20537 already got a cookie.
20538
20539 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20540 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20541 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20542 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20543 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20544
20545 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20546 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20547 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20548
20549 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20550 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20551 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20552
20553 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20554 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20555
20556 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20557 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20558 then advertised in the response.
20559
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205618.6. Non-printable characters
20562-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020563
20564In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20565consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20566converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20567prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20568being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20569escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20570is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20571'}' when logging headers.
20572
20573Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20574issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20575containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20576
20577Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20578the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20579performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20580
20581
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205828.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20583---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020584
20585Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20586achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020587section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020588cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20589the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20590the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020591locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020592not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20593user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20594a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20595wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20596
20597 Examples :
20598 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20599 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20600
20601 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20602 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
20603
20604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206058.8. Capturing HTTP headers
20606---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020607
20608Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
20609proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
20610the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
20611server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
20612
20613Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
20614response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020615section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020616
20617It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020618time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
20619appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020620are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
20621and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
20622follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
20623request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
20624in the logs.
20625
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020626As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
20627frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
20628an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
20629
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020630 Example :
20631 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
20632 listen proxy-out
20633 mode http
20634 option httplog
20635 option logasap
20636 log global
20637 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
20638
20639 # log the name of the virtual server
20640 capture request header Host len 20
20641
20642 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
20643 capture request header Content-Length len 10
20644
20645 # log the beginning of the referrer
20646 capture request header Referer len 20
20647
20648 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
20649 capture response header Server len 20
20650
20651 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
20652 capture response header Content-Length len 10
20653
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020654 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020655 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
20656
20657 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
20658 capture response header Via len 20
20659
20660 # log the URL location during a redirection
20661 capture response header Location len 20
20662
20663 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
20664 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
20665 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20666 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
20667 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
20668
20669 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20670 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20671 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20672 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020673 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020674
20675 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
20676 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
20677 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
20678 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
20679 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020680 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020681
20682
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206838.9. Examples of logs
20684---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020685
20686These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
20687them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
20688reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
20689
20690 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
20691 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20692 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20693
20694 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
20695 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
20696
20697 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
20698 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
20699 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
20700
20701 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
20702 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
20703
20704 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
20705 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
20706 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
20707
20708 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020709 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020710 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
20711 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
20712
20713 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
20714 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
20715 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
20716
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020020717 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
20718 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
20719 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
20720 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
20721 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
20722 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020723
20724 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020725 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020726
20727 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
20728 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
20729 Nothing was sent to any server.
20730
20731 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
20732 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
20733
20734 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
20735 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020736 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020737 send a 408 return code to the client.
20738
20739 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
20740 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
20741
20742 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
20743 5 seconds ("c----").
20744
20745 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
20746 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020747 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020748
20749 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020750 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020751 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
20752 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
20753 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
20754 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
20755 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020756
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020020757
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200207589. Supported filters
20759--------------------
20760
20761Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
20762accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
20763unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
20764
20765See also : "filter"
20766
207679.1. Trace
20768----------
20769
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010020770filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020771
20772 Arguments:
20773 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
20774 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
20775
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010020776 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020777
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020778 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020779 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
20780 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
20781 amount of the parsed data.
20782
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020783 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010020784
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020785This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
20786callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
20787information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
20788filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
20789
20790Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
20791tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
20792a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
20793
20794
207959.2. HTTP compression
20796---------------------
20797
20798filter compression
20799
20800The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
20801keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020802when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
20803fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
20804done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
20805explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
20806filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
20807listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20808order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020809
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020810See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
20811 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020020812
20813
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200208149.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
20815--------------------------------------------
20816
20817filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
20818
20819 Arguments :
20820
20821 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
20822 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
20823 parsed.
20824
20825 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
20826 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
20827 part must be placed in its own scope.
20828
20829The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
20830external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020831streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020832exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
20833also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
20834
20835SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
20836the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
20837
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020838For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020020839"doc/SPOE.txt".
20840
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100208419.4. Cache
20842----------
20843
20844filter cache <name>
20845
20846 Arguments :
20847
20848 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
20849
20850The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
20851"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020852cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020853other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
20854case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
20855is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
20856filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010020857listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20858order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010020859
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020860See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
20861 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
20862
20863
208649.5. Fcgi-app
20865-------------
20866
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040020867filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020868
20869 Arguments :
20870
20871 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
20872
20873The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
20874request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
20875reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
20876used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
20877implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
20878used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
20879fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
20880used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
20881order.
20882
20883See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
20884 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
20885
20886
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100208879.6. OpenTracing
20888----------------
20889
20890The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
20891HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
20892of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
20893Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
20894
20895This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
20896
20897The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
20898HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
20899participates in the work of HAProxy.
20900
20901filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
20902
20903 Arguments :
20904
20905 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
20906 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
20907 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
20908 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
20909 OpenTracing filters.
20910
20911 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
20912 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
20913 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
20914 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
20915 filter must have its own scope defined.
20916
20917More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
20918of the filter can be found in the contrib/opentracing directory.
20919
20920
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002092110. FastCGI applications
20922-------------------------
20923
20924HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
20925feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
20926the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
20927FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
20928servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
20929FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
20930backend.
20931
20932HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
20933application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
20934connection.
20935
2093610.1. Setup
20937-----------
20938
2093910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
20940--------------------------
20941
20942fcgi-app <name>
20943 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
20944 document root must be defined.
20945
20946acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
20947 Declare or complete an access list.
20948
20949 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
20950 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
20951 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
20952 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
20953 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
20954
20955docroot <path>
20956 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
20957 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
20958 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
20959
20960index <script-name>
20961 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
20962 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
20963 is an optional setting.
20964
20965 Example :
20966 index index.php
20967
20968log-stderr global
20969log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010020970 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020971 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
20972
20973 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
20974 default STDERR messages are ignored.
20975
20976pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
20977 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
20978 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
20979 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
20980
20981 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
20982 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
20983 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
20984 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
20985
20986 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
20987 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
20988
20989path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020990 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010020991 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
20992 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
20993 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
20994 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
20995 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
20996 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
20997 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010020998
20999 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021000 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021001 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21002 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21003 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21004 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021005
21006 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021007 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21008 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021009
21010option get-values
21011no option get-values
21012 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21013
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021014 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021015 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21016
21017 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21018 application will accept.
21019
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021020 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21021 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021022
21023 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021024 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021025 option is disabled.
21026
21027 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21028 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21029 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21030 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21031 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21032 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21033
21034option keep-conn
21035no option keep-conn
21036 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21037 sending a response.
21038
21039 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21040 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21041
21042option max-reqs <reqs>
21043 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21044 accept.
21045
21046 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21047 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21048 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21049 to 1.
21050
21051option mpxs-conns
21052no option mpxs-conns
21053 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21054
21055 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21056 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21057
21058set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21059 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21060 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21061 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21062 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21063
21064 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21065 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21066 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21067
21068 Example :
21069 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21070 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21071
21072 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21073
21074
2107510.1.2. Proxy section
21076---------------------
21077
21078use-fcgi-app <name>
21079 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21080
21081 Arguments :
21082 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21083
21084 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21085 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21086 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21087 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21088 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21089
21090 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21091 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21092 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21093 application are evaluated.
21094
21095
2109610.1.3. Example
21097---------------
21098
21099 frontend front-http
21100 mode http
21101 bind *:80
21102 bind *:
21103
21104 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21105 default_backend back-static
21106
21107 backend back-static
21108 mode http
21109 server www A.B.C.D:80
21110
21111 backend back-dynamic
21112 mode http
21113 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21114 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21115
21116 fcgi-app php-fpm
21117 log-stderr global
21118 option keep-conn
21119
21120 docroot /var/www/my-app
21121 index index.php
21122 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21123
21124
2112510.2. Default parameters
21126------------------------
21127
21128A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21129the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021130script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021131applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21132
21133 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21134 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21135 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21136 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21137 | | |
21138 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21139 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21140 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21141 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21142 | | application. |
21143 | | |
21144 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21145 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21146 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21147 | | |
21148 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21149 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21150 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21151 | | the application's configuration. |
21152 | | |
21153 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21154 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21155 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21156 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21157 | | |
21158 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21159 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21160 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21161 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21162 | | be defined. |
21163 | | |
21164 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21165 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21166 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21167 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21168 | | is not set too. |
21169 | | |
21170 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21171 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21172 | | set. |
21173 | | |
21174 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21175 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21176 | | the request. |
21177 | | |
21178 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21179 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21180 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21181 | | |
21182 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21183 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21184 | | script to process the request. |
21185 | | |
21186 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21187 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21188 | | |
21189 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21190 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21191 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21192 | | |
21193 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21194 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21195 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21196 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21197 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21198 | | |
21199 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21200 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21201 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21202 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21203 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21204 | | side. |
21205 | | |
21206 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21207 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21208 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21209 | | connected to. |
21210 | | |
21211 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21212 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21213 | | |
21214 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21215 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21216 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21217 | | |
21218 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21219
21220
2122110.3. Limitations
21222------------------
21223
21224The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21225way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21226during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21227establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21228application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21229or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21230message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21231these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21232and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21233
21234Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21235request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21236requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21237
21238About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21239into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21240fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21241"http-request" ones.
21242
21243Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21244FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21245processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21246must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21247here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021248
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021249/*
21250 * Local variables:
21251 * fill-column: 79
21252 * End:
21253 */